diff options
author | That-Canadian <poole.chris.11@gmail.com> | 2017-08-03 10:52:30 -0400 |
---|---|---|
committer | That-Canadian <poole.chris.11@gmail.com> | 2017-08-03 10:52:30 -0400 |
commit | c33434c0d64dd7cbd5f6371c7cb4ac5e05924944 (patch) | |
tree | 59fe34d95089a59fa4e615fd995c81d274147bba /lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII | |
parent | db5bb7dbbfa2d2eb4f41aa4c768c3c5c8d73f563 (diff) | |
parent | 07ba06d0b6e516bcfa4cbccbed9cfd8dc131072a (diff) |
Merge branch 'master' into eco-keyboard
Diffstat (limited to 'lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII')
38 files changed, 8264 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/AVRISP-MKII.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/AVRISP-MKII.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a734d960ba --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/AVRISP-MKII.c @@ -0,0 +1,164 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the AVRISP project. This file contains the main tasks of + * the project and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "AVRISP-MKII.h" + +#if (BOARD != BOARD_NONE) + /* Some board hardware definitions (e.g. the Arduino Micro) have their LEDs defined on the same pins + as the ISP, PDI or TPI interfaces (see the accompanying project documentation). If a board other + than NONE is selected (to enable the LED driver with the programmer) you should double-check that + no conflicts will occur. If there is a conflict, turn off the LEDs (set BOARD to NONE in the makefile) + or define a custom board driver (see the LUFA manual) with alternative LED mappings. + */ + #warning Board specific drivers have been selected; make sure the board LED driver does not conflict with the programmer ISP/PDI/TPI interfaces. +#endif + +/** Main program entry point. This routine contains the overall program flow, including initial + * setup of all components and the main program loop. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + V2Protocol_Init(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + #if (BOARD == BOARD_USBTINYMKII) + /* On the USBTINY-MKII target, there is a secondary LED which indicates the current selected power + mode - either VBUS, or sourced from the VTARGET pin of the programming connectors */ + LEDs_ChangeLEDs(LEDMASK_VBUSPOWER, (PIND & (1 << 0)) ? 0 : LEDMASK_VBUSPOWER); + #endif + + AVRISP_Task(); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + LEDs_Init(); + #if defined(RESET_TOGGLES_LIBUSB_COMPAT) + UpdateCurrentCompatibilityMode(); + #endif + + /* USB Stack Initialization */ + USB_Init(); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Connection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Disconnection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Configuration Changed event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + /* Setup AVRISP Data OUT endpoint */ + ConfigSuccess &= Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_OUT_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_BULK, AVRISP_DATA_EPSIZE, 1); + + /* Setup AVRISP Data IN endpoint if it is using a physically different endpoint */ + if ((AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR & ENDPOINT_EPNUM_MASK) != (AVRISP_DATA_OUT_EPADDR & ENDPOINT_EPNUM_MASK)) + ConfigSuccess &= Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_BULK, AVRISP_DATA_EPSIZE, 1); + + /* Indicate endpoint configuration success or failure */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Processes incoming V2 Protocol commands from the host, returning a response when required. */ +void AVRISP_Task(void) +{ + /* Device must be connected and configured for the task to run */ + if (USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) + return; + + V2Params_UpdateParamValues(); + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_OUT_EPADDR); + + /* Check to see if a V2 Protocol command has been received */ + if (Endpoint_IsOUTReceived()) + { + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_BUSY); + + /* Pass off processing of the V2 Protocol command to the V2 Protocol handler */ + V2Protocol_ProcessCommand(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); + } +} + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + * + * \param[in] wValue Descriptor type and index to retrieve + * \param[in] wIndex Sub-index to retrieve (such as a localized string language) + * \param[out] DescriptorAddress Address of the retrieved descriptor + * + * \return Length of the retrieved descriptor in bytes, or NO_DESCRIPTOR if the descriptor was not found + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + return AVRISP_GetDescriptor(wValue, wIndex, DescriptorAddress); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/AVRISP-MKII.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/AVRISP-MKII.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ae2d041484 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/AVRISP-MKII.h @@ -0,0 +1,90 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for AVRISP.c. + */ + +#ifndef _AVRISP_H_ +#define _AVRISP_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + #if defined(ADC) + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/ADC.h> + #endif + + #include "AVRISPDescriptors.h" + #include "Lib/V2Protocol.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY LEDS_LED2 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is busy. */ + #define LEDMASK_BUSY (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the target is being powered by VBUS. */ + #define LEDMASK_VBUSPOWER LEDS_LED3 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void AVRISP_Task(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/AVRISP-MKII.txt b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/AVRISP-MKII.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..76d612ec05 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/AVRISP-MKII.txt @@ -0,0 +1,346 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage AVRISP MKII Programmer Project + * + * \section Sec_Compat Project Compatibility + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this project. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) + * \li Series 2 USB AVRs (AT90USBxx2, ATMEGAxxU2) - <i>8KB versions with reduced features only</i> + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this project. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Vendor Specific Class</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>Atmel AVRISP MKII Protocol Specification</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description + * + * Firmware for an Atmel Studio compatible AVRISP-MKII clone programmer. This project will enable the USB + * AVR series of microcontrollers to act as a clone of the official Atmel AVRISP-MKII programmer, usable within + * Atmel Studio or with any software capable of driving a real Atmel AVRISP-MKII programmer. In its most + * basic form, it allows for the programming of AVR TINY, MEGA and XMEGA devices at the programmer's VCC voltage from + * within Atmel Studio with no special hardware other than the USB AVR and the parts needed for the USB + * interface. If the user desires, more advanced circuits incorporating level conversion can be made to allow for the + * programming of target AVRs running at a different voltage to the programmer. + * + * This device spoofs Atmel's official AVRISP-MKII device PID so that it remains compatible with Atmel's AVRISP-MKII + * drivers. It is currently tested working under the following configurations: + * + * - <b>Windows:</b> Atmel Studio 7, with alternative driver + * - <b>Windows:</b> AVRDUDE 6.2, with alternative driver + * - <b>Linux:</b> AVRDUDE 6.1 + * + * <b>Note that this clone requires a libUSB based driver under Windows,</b> due to an incompatible change in the official + * Jungo based driver. The alternative driver given here will function with both real and clone AVRISP devices in Atmel + * Studio 7 onwards under Windows - and as a bonus, also provides AVRDude access to the programmer. + * + * As of Atmel Studio version 7.0.1417 the legacy Jungo driver has been deprecated in favor of an official libUSB based + * driver, making the driver packaged here superfluous. Use the driver packaged here only if you are still using an earlier + * Atmel Studio 7 build, otherwise the official Atmel libUSB driver should be used. + * + * Note that this design currently has the following limitations: + * - No reversed/shorted target connector detection and notification + * - A separate header is required for each of the ISP, PDI and TPI programming protocols that the user wishes to use + * + * On AVR models with an ADC converter, the USB AVR's AVCC pin should be tied to 5V (e.g. VBUS) and the + * \c VTARGET_ADC_CHANNEL token should be set to an appropriate ADC channel number in the project makefile for VTARGET + * detection to operate correctly. On models without an ADC converter, VTARGET will report a fixed 3.3V level at all times + * which should allow the programmer to remain compatible at the protocol level with all AVR devices. + * + * While this application can be compiled for USB AVRs with as little as 8KB of FLASH, for full functionality 16KB or more + * of FLASH is required. On 8KB devices, ISP or PDI/TPI protocol programming support can be disabled to reduce program size. + * + * \section Sec_KnownIssues Known Issues: + * + * \par XMEGA EEPROM programming fails in some cases. + * Several users have reported that XMEGA EEPROM programming fails unless the chip is erased first. If a non-blank EEPROM + * is present, writing further EEPROM data causes corruption. + * <a href="https://github.com/abcminiuser/lufa/issues/25">LUFA issue tracker entry</a>. + * + * \section Sec_Installation Installation + * The programmer supports multiple platforms, both Windows and Linux. + * + * \subsection SSec_LinuxInstallation Linux Installation + * On Linux systems, the programmer should be usable out of the box with no special setup other than (on some systems) + * editing of the system permissions to allow the programmer to be used from a non-elevated (root) context. The programmer + * is compatible with the free open source AVRDude programming software project. + * + * \subsection SSec_WindowsInstallation Windows Installation + * On Windows systems, due to an unfortunate limitation of the USB AVR devices and the Atmel Studio platform, the programmer + * requires an alternative libUSB based driver. Uninstall the existing Jungo driver for the device (if installed) and replace + * it with the driver that ships with this project, to enable access to the programmer in Atmel Studio and AVRDUDE. + * + * \section Sec_ISP ISP Connections + * Connections to the device for SPI programming (when enabled): + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <th><b>Programmer Pin:</b></th> + * <th><b>Target Device Pin:</b></th> + * <th><b>ISP 6 Pin Layout:</b></th> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>MISO</td> + * <td>PDO</td> + * <td>1</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ADCx <b><sup>1</sup></b></td> + * <td>VTARGET</td> + * <td>2</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>SCLK</td> + * <td>SCLK</td> + * <td>3</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>MOSI</td> + * <td>PDI</td> + * <td>4</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>PORTx.y <b><sup>2</sup></b></td> + * <td>/RESET</td> + * <td>5</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>GND</td> + * <td>GND</td> + * <td>6</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * In addition, the AVR's OCR1A pin will generate a 4MHz clock, to act as an external rescue device clock if the + * fuses have been mis-set. To use the recovery clock, connect the OCR1A pin of the USB AVR to the target AVR's + * XTAL1 pin, and set the ISP programming speed to 125KHz (note: other ISP speeds will not work correctly). + * + * <b><sup>1</sup></b> <i>Optional, see \ref Sec_Options section - for USB AVRs with ADC modules only</i> \n + * <b><sup>2</sup></b> <i>See AUX line related tokens in the \ref Sec_Options section</i> + * + * \section Sec_PDI PDI Connections + * Connections to the device for PDI programming (when enabled): + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <th><b>Programmer Pin:</b></th> + * <th><b>Target Device Pin:</b></th> + * <th><b>PDI 6 Pin Layout:</b></th> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>Tx/Rx <b><sup>2</sup></b></td> + * <td>DATA</td> + * <td>1</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ADCx <b><sup>1</sup></b></td> + * <td>VTARGET</td> + * <td>2</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>N/A</td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * <td>3</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>N/A</td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * <td>4</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>XCK</td> + * <td>CLOCK</td> + * <td>5</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>GND</td> + * <td>GND</td> + * <td>6</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * <b><sup>1</sup></b> <i>Optional, see \ref Sec_Options section - for USB AVRs with ADC modules only</i> \n + * <b><sup>2</sup></b> <i>The AVR's Tx and Rx become the DATA line when connected together via a pair of 220 ohm resistors</i> \n + * + * \section Sec_TPI TPI Connections + * Connections to the device for TPI programming (when enabled): + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <th><b>Programmer Pin:</b></th> + * <th><b>Target Device Pin:</b></th> + * <th><b>TPI 6 Pin Layout:</b></th> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>Tx/Rx <b><sup>2</sup></b></td> + * <td>DATA</td> + * <td>1</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ADCx <b><sup>1</sup></b></td> + * <td>VTARGET</td> + * <td>2</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>XCK <b><sup>2</sup></b></td> + * <td>CLOCK</td> + * <td>3</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>N/A</td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * <td>4</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>PORTx.y <b><sup>3</sup></b></td> + * <td>/RESET</td> + * <td>5</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>GND</td> + * <td>GND</td> + * <td>6</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * <b><sup>1</sup></b> <i>Optional, see \ref Sec_Options section - for USB AVRs with ADC modules only</i> \n + * <b><sup>2</sup></b> <i>The AVR's Tx and Rx become the DATA line when connected together via a pair of 220 ohm resistors</i> \n + * <b><sup>3</sup></b> <i>See AUX line related tokens in the \ref Sec_Options section</i> + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this project, which can control the project behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <th><b>Define Name:</b></th> + * <th><b>Location:</b></th> + * <th><b>Description:</b></th> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AUX_LINE_PORT</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>PORT register for the programmer's AUX target line. The use of this line varies between the programming protocols, + * but is generally used for the target's /RESET line. + * \n \n <i>Ignored when compiled for the XPLAIN board.</i></td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AUX_LINE_PIN</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>PIN register for the programmer's AUX target line. The use of this line varies between the programming protocols, + * but is generally used for the target's /RESET line. + * \n \n <i>Ignored when compiled for the XPLAIN board.</i></td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AUX_LINE_DDR</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>DDR register for the programmer's AUX target line. The use of this line varies between the programming protocols, + * but is generally used for the target's /RESET line. + * \n \n <i>Ignored when compiled for the XPLAIN board.</i></td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AUX_LINE_MASK</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Mask for the programmer's AUX target line. The use of this line varies between the programming protocols, + * but is generally used for the target's /RESET line. <b>Must not be the AVR's /SS pin</b>. + * \n \n <i>Ignored when compiled for the XPLAIN board.</i></td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>VTARGET_ADC_CHANNEL</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>ADC channel number (on supported AVRs) to use for VTARGET level detection, if NO_VTARGET_DETECT is not defined. + * \n \n <i>Ignored when compiled for targets lacking an ADC.</i></td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ENABLE_ISP_PROTOCOL</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Define to enable SPI programming protocol support. + * \n \n <i>Ignored when compiled for the XPLAIN board.</i></td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Define to enable PDI and TPI programming protocol support. + * \n \n <i>Ignored when compiled for the XPLAIN board.</i></td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>NO_VTARGET_DETECT</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Define to disable VTARGET sampling and reporting on AVR models with an ADC converter. This will cause the programmer + * to report a fixed 3.3V target voltage to the host regardless of the real target voltage. + * \n \n <i>Ignored when compiled for targets lacking an ADC.</i></td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>VTARGET_REF_VOLTS</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Indicates the programmer AVR's AVCC reference voltage when measuring the target's supply voltage. Note that the supply + * voltage should never exceed the reference voltage on the programmer AVR without some form of protection to prevent damage + * to the ADC. + * \n \n <i>Ignored when compiled for targets lacking an ADC, or when NO_VTARGET_DETECT is defined.</i></td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>VTARGET_USE_INTERNAL_REF</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Selects the internal 2.56V ADC reference voltage, instead of using the AVR's VREF pin. When enabled, this option will + * override the VTARGET_REF_VOLTS configuration option. + * \n \n <i>Ignored when compiled for targets lacking an ADC, or when NO_VTARGET_DETECT is defined.</i></td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>VTARGET_SCALE_FACTOR</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Indicates the target's supply voltage scale factor when applied to the ADC. A simple resistive divider can be used on the + * ADC pin for measuring the target's supply voltage, so that voltages above the programmer AVR's AVCC reference voltage can be + * measured. This should be the reciprocal of the division performed - e.g. if the VTARGET voltage is halved, this should be set + * to 2. + * \n \n <i>Ignored when compiled for targets lacking an ADC, or when NO_VTARGET_DETECT is defined.</i></td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>XCK_RESCUE_CLOCK_ENABLE</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Define to move the ISP rescue clock to the AVR's XCK pin instead of the OCR1A output pin. This is useful for existing programming + * hardware that does not expose the OCR1A pin of the AVR, but <i>may</i> cause some issues with PDI programming mode.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>INVERTED_ISP_MISO</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Define to invert the received data on the ISP MISO line. This is sometimes needed depending on the level translation hardware used, + * if the translator hardware inverts the received logic level.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>FIRMWARE_VERSION_MINOR</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Define to set the minor firmware revision nunber reported to the host on request. By default this will use a firmware version compatible + * with the latest Atmel IDE version, however if desired the reported minor value can be adjusted here.</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/AVRISPDescriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/AVRISPDescriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f4210fbbbf --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/AVRISPDescriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,203 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "AVRISPDescriptors.h" + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM AVRISP_DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = USB_CSCP_VendorSpecificClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x2104, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(2,0,0), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = AVRISP_STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = AVRISP_STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = AVRISP_STRING_ID_Serial, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const AVRISP_USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM AVRISP_ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(AVRISP_USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 1, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED), + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .AVRISP_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_AVRISP, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 2, + + .Class = USB_CSCP_VendorSpecificClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .AVRISP_DataInEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = AVRISP_DATA_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x0A + }, + + .AVRISP_DataOutEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = AVRISP_DATA_OUT_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = AVRISP_DATA_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x0A + }, +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM AVRISP_LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM AVRISP_ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"ATMEL"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM AVRISP_ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"AVRISP mkII"); + +/** Serial number string. This is a Unicode string containing the device's unique serial number, expressed as a + * series of uppercase hexadecimal digits. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM AVRISP_SerialString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"000200012345\0" + // Note: Real AVRISP-MKII has the embedded NUL byte, bug in firmware? +); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t AVRISP_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &AVRISP_DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &AVRISP_ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(AVRISP_USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case AVRISP_STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &AVRISP_LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&AVRISP_LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case AVRISP_STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &AVRISP_ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&AVRISP_ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case AVRISP_STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &AVRISP_ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&AVRISP_ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + case AVRISP_STRING_ID_Serial: + Address = &AVRISP_SerialString; + Size = AVRISP_SerialString.Header.Size; + break; + } + + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/AVRISPDescriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/AVRISPDescriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..56dcf25a9b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/AVRISPDescriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,100 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the AVRISP data OUT endpoint. */ + #define AVRISP_DATA_OUT_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 2) + + /** Endpoint address of the AVRISP data IN endpoint. */ + #define AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 2) + + /** Size in bytes of the AVRISP data endpoint. */ + #define AVRISP_DATA_EPSIZE 64 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // Atmel AVRISP-MKII Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t AVRISP_Interface; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t AVRISP_DataInEndpoint; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t AVRISP_DataOutEndpoint; + } AVRISP_USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_AVRISP = 0, /**< AVRISP interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum AVRISP_StringDescriptors_t + { + AVRISP_STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + AVRISP_STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + AVRISP_STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + AVRISP_STRING_ID_Serial = 3, /**< Serial number string ID */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t AVRISP_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Config/AppConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Config/AppConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a2d15abdc9 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Config/AppConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,68 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Application Configuration Header File + * + * This is a header file which is be used to configure some of + * the application's compile time options, as an alternative to + * specifying the compile time constants supplied through a + * makefile or build system. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the + * \ref Sec_Options section of the application documentation. + */ + +#ifndef _APP_CONFIG_H_ +#define _APP_CONFIG_H_ + + #define AUX_LINE_PORT PORTB + #define AUX_LINE_PIN PINB + #define AUX_LINE_DDR DDRB + #if (BOARD == BOARD_U2S) + #define AUX_LINE_MASK (1 << 0) + #else + #define AUX_LINE_MASK (1 << 4) + #endif + + #define ENABLE_ISP_PROTOCOL + #define ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL + + #define VTARGET_ADC_CHANNEL 2 + #define VTARGET_REF_VOLTS 5 + #define VTARGET_SCALE_FACTOR 1 +// #define VTARGET_USE_INTERNAL_REF + #define NO_VTARGET_DETECT +// #define XCK_RESCUE_CLOCK_ENABLE +// #define INVERTED_ISP_MISO + +// #define FIRMWARE_VERSION_MINOR 0x11 + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ed160230ca --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT + #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS + #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 16 + #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR 0 + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT + #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP + #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/ISP/ISPProtocol.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/ISP/ISPProtocol.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6553504d5e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/ISP/ISPProtocol.c @@ -0,0 +1,531 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * ISP Protocol handler, to process V2 Protocol wrapped ISP commands used in Atmel programmer devices. + */ + +#include "ISPProtocol.h" + +#if defined(ENABLE_ISP_PROTOCOL) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + +/** Handler for the CMD_ENTER_PROGMODE_ISP command, which attempts to enter programming mode on + * the attached device, returning success or failure back to the host. + */ +void ISPProtocol_EnterISPMode(void) +{ + struct + { + uint8_t TimeoutMS; + uint8_t PinStabDelayMS; + uint8_t ExecutionDelayMS; + uint8_t SynchLoops; + uint8_t ByteDelay; + uint8_t PollValue; + uint8_t PollIndex; + uint8_t EnterProgBytes[4]; + } Enter_ISP_Params; + + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&Enter_ISP_Params, sizeof(Enter_ISP_Params), NULL); + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + uint8_t ResponseStatus = STATUS_CMD_FAILED; + + CurrentAddress = 0; + + /* Perform execution delay, initialize SPI bus */ + ISPProtocol_DelayMS(Enter_ISP_Params.ExecutionDelayMS); + ISPTarget_EnableTargetISP(); + + ISPTarget_ChangeTargetResetLine(true); + ISPProtocol_DelayMS(Enter_ISP_Params.PinStabDelayMS); + + /* Continuously attempt to synchronize with the target until either the number of attempts specified + * by the host has exceeded, or the the device sends back the expected response values */ + while (Enter_ISP_Params.SynchLoops-- && TimeoutTicksRemaining) + { + uint8_t ResponseBytes[4]; + + for (uint8_t RByte = 0; RByte < sizeof(ResponseBytes); RByte++) + { + ISPProtocol_DelayMS(Enter_ISP_Params.ByteDelay); + ResponseBytes[RByte] = ISPTarget_TransferByte(Enter_ISP_Params.EnterProgBytes[RByte]); + } + + /* Check if polling disabled, or if the polled value matches the expected value */ + if (!(Enter_ISP_Params.PollIndex) || (ResponseBytes[Enter_ISP_Params.PollIndex - 1] == Enter_ISP_Params.PollValue)) + { + ResponseStatus = STATUS_CMD_OK; + break; + } + else + { + ISPTarget_ChangeTargetResetLine(false); + ISPProtocol_DelayMS(Enter_ISP_Params.PinStabDelayMS); + ISPTarget_ChangeTargetResetLine(true); + ISPProtocol_DelayMS(Enter_ISP_Params.PinStabDelayMS); + } + } + + Endpoint_Write_8(CMD_ENTER_PROGMODE_ISP); + Endpoint_Write_8(ResponseStatus); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + +/** Handler for the CMD_LEAVE_ISP command, which releases the target from programming mode. */ +void ISPProtocol_LeaveISPMode(void) +{ + struct + { + uint8_t PreDelayMS; + uint8_t PostDelayMS; + } Leave_ISP_Params; + + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&Leave_ISP_Params, sizeof(Leave_ISP_Params), NULL); + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + /* Perform pre-exit delay, release the target /RESET, disable the SPI bus and perform the post-exit delay */ + ISPProtocol_DelayMS(Leave_ISP_Params.PreDelayMS); + ISPTarget_ChangeTargetResetLine(false); + ISPTarget_DisableTargetISP(); + ISPProtocol_DelayMS(Leave_ISP_Params.PostDelayMS); + + Endpoint_Write_8(CMD_LEAVE_PROGMODE_ISP); + Endpoint_Write_8(STATUS_CMD_OK); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + +/** Handler for the CMD_PROGRAM_FLASH_ISP and CMD_PROGRAM_EEPROM_ISP commands, writing out bytes, + * words or pages of data to the attached device. + * + * \param[in] V2Command Issued V2 Protocol command byte from the host + */ +void ISPProtocol_ProgramMemory(uint8_t V2Command) +{ + struct + { + uint16_t BytesToWrite; + uint8_t ProgrammingMode; + uint8_t DelayMS; + uint8_t ProgrammingCommands[3]; + uint8_t PollValue1; + uint8_t PollValue2; + uint8_t ProgData[256]; // Note, the Jungo driver has a very short ACK timeout period, need to buffer the + } Write_Memory_Params; // whole page and ACK the packet as fast as possible to prevent it from aborting + + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&Write_Memory_Params, (sizeof(Write_Memory_Params) - + sizeof(Write_Memory_Params.ProgData)), NULL); + Write_Memory_Params.BytesToWrite = SwapEndian_16(Write_Memory_Params.BytesToWrite); + + if (Write_Memory_Params.BytesToWrite > sizeof(Write_Memory_Params.ProgData)) + { + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + Endpoint_Write_8(V2Command); + Endpoint_Write_8(STATUS_CMD_FAILED); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + return; + } + + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&Write_Memory_Params.ProgData, Write_Memory_Params.BytesToWrite, NULL); + + // The driver will terminate transfers that are a round multiple of the endpoint bank in size with a ZLP, need + // to catch this and discard it before continuing on with packet processing to prevent communication issues + if (((sizeof(uint8_t) + sizeof(Write_Memory_Params) - sizeof(Write_Memory_Params.ProgData)) + + Write_Memory_Params.BytesToWrite) % AVRISP_DATA_EPSIZE == 0) + { + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_WaitUntilReady(); + } + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + uint8_t ProgrammingStatus = STATUS_CMD_OK; + uint8_t PollValue = (V2Command == CMD_PROGRAM_FLASH_ISP) ? Write_Memory_Params.PollValue1 : + Write_Memory_Params.PollValue2; + uint16_t PollAddress = 0; + uint8_t* NextWriteByte = Write_Memory_Params.ProgData; + uint16_t PageStartAddress = (CurrentAddress & 0xFFFF); + + for (uint16_t CurrentByte = 0; CurrentByte < Write_Memory_Params.BytesToWrite; CurrentByte++) + { + uint8_t ByteToWrite = *(NextWriteByte++); + uint8_t ProgrammingMode = Write_Memory_Params.ProgrammingMode; + + /* Check to see if we need to send a LOAD EXTENDED ADDRESS command to the target */ + if (MustLoadExtendedAddress) + { + ISPTarget_LoadExtendedAddress(); + MustLoadExtendedAddress = false; + } + + ISPTarget_SendByte(Write_Memory_Params.ProgrammingCommands[0]); + ISPTarget_SendByte(CurrentAddress >> 8); + ISPTarget_SendByte(CurrentAddress & 0xFF); + ISPTarget_SendByte(ByteToWrite); + + /* AVR FLASH addressing requires us to modify the write command based on if we are writing a high + * or low byte at the current word address */ + if (V2Command == CMD_PROGRAM_FLASH_ISP) + Write_Memory_Params.ProgrammingCommands[0] ^= READ_WRITE_HIGH_BYTE_MASK; + + /* Check to see if we have a valid polling address */ + if (!(PollAddress) && (ByteToWrite != PollValue)) + { + if ((CurrentByte & 0x01) && (V2Command == CMD_PROGRAM_FLASH_ISP)) + Write_Memory_Params.ProgrammingCommands[2] |= READ_WRITE_HIGH_BYTE_MASK; + else + Write_Memory_Params.ProgrammingCommands[2] &= ~READ_WRITE_HIGH_BYTE_MASK; + + PollAddress = (CurrentAddress & 0xFFFF); + } + + /* If in word programming mode, commit the byte to the target's memory */ + if (!(ProgrammingMode & PROG_MODE_PAGED_WRITES_MASK)) + { + /* If the current polling address is invalid, switch to timed delay write completion mode */ + if (!(PollAddress) && !(ProgrammingMode & PROG_MODE_WORD_READYBUSY_MASK)) + ProgrammingMode = (ProgrammingMode & ~PROG_MODE_WORD_VALUE_MASK) | PROG_MODE_WORD_TIMEDELAY_MASK; + + ProgrammingStatus = ISPTarget_WaitForProgComplete(ProgrammingMode, PollAddress, PollValue, + Write_Memory_Params.DelayMS, + Write_Memory_Params.ProgrammingCommands[2]); + + /* Abort the programming loop early if the byte/word programming failed */ + if (ProgrammingStatus != STATUS_CMD_OK) + break; + + /* Must reset the polling address afterwards, so it is not erroneously used for the next byte */ + PollAddress = 0; + } + + /* EEPROM just increments the address each byte, flash needs to increment on each word and + * also check to ensure that a LOAD EXTENDED ADDRESS command is issued each time the extended + * address boundary has been crossed during FLASH memory programming */ + if ((CurrentByte & 0x01) || (V2Command == CMD_PROGRAM_EEPROM_ISP)) + { + CurrentAddress++; + + if ((V2Command == CMD_PROGRAM_FLASH_ISP) && !(CurrentAddress & 0xFFFF)) + MustLoadExtendedAddress = true; + } + } + + /* If the current page must be committed, send the PROGRAM PAGE command to the target */ + if (Write_Memory_Params.ProgrammingMode & PROG_MODE_COMMIT_PAGE_MASK) + { + ISPTarget_SendByte(Write_Memory_Params.ProgrammingCommands[1]); + ISPTarget_SendByte(PageStartAddress >> 8); + ISPTarget_SendByte(PageStartAddress & 0xFF); + ISPTarget_SendByte(0x00); + + /* Check if polling is enabled and possible, if not switch to timed delay mode */ + if ((Write_Memory_Params.ProgrammingMode & PROG_MODE_PAGED_VALUE_MASK) && !(PollAddress)) + { + Write_Memory_Params.ProgrammingMode = (Write_Memory_Params.ProgrammingMode & ~PROG_MODE_PAGED_VALUE_MASK) | + PROG_MODE_PAGED_TIMEDELAY_MASK; + } + + ProgrammingStatus = ISPTarget_WaitForProgComplete(Write_Memory_Params.ProgrammingMode, PollAddress, PollValue, + Write_Memory_Params.DelayMS, + Write_Memory_Params.ProgrammingCommands[2]); + + /* Check to see if the FLASH address has crossed the extended address boundary */ + if ((V2Command == CMD_PROGRAM_FLASH_ISP) && !(CurrentAddress & 0xFFFF)) + MustLoadExtendedAddress = true; + } + + Endpoint_Write_8(V2Command); + Endpoint_Write_8(ProgrammingStatus); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + +/** Handler for the CMD_READ_FLASH_ISP and CMD_READ_EEPROM_ISP commands, reading in bytes, + * words or pages of data from the attached device. + * + * \param[in] V2Command Issued V2 Protocol command byte from the host + */ +void ISPProtocol_ReadMemory(uint8_t V2Command) +{ + struct + { + uint16_t BytesToRead; + uint8_t ReadMemoryCommand; + } Read_Memory_Params; + + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&Read_Memory_Params, sizeof(Read_Memory_Params), NULL); + Read_Memory_Params.BytesToRead = SwapEndian_16(Read_Memory_Params.BytesToRead); + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + Endpoint_Write_8(V2Command); + Endpoint_Write_8(STATUS_CMD_OK); + + /* Read each byte from the device and write them to the packet for the host */ + for (uint16_t CurrentByte = 0; CurrentByte < Read_Memory_Params.BytesToRead; CurrentByte++) + { + /* Check to see if we need to send a LOAD EXTENDED ADDRESS command to the target */ + if (MustLoadExtendedAddress) + { + ISPTarget_LoadExtendedAddress(); + MustLoadExtendedAddress = false; + } + + /* Read the next byte from the desired memory space in the device */ + ISPTarget_SendByte(Read_Memory_Params.ReadMemoryCommand); + ISPTarget_SendByte(CurrentAddress >> 8); + ISPTarget_SendByte(CurrentAddress & 0xFF); + Endpoint_Write_8(ISPTarget_ReceiveByte()); + + /* Check if the endpoint bank is currently full, if so send the packet */ + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + Endpoint_WaitUntilReady(); + } + + /* AVR FLASH addressing requires us to modify the read command based on if we are reading a high + * or low byte at the current word address */ + if (V2Command == CMD_READ_FLASH_ISP) + Read_Memory_Params.ReadMemoryCommand ^= READ_WRITE_HIGH_BYTE_MASK; + + /* EEPROM just increments the address each byte, flash needs to increment on each word and + * also check to ensure that a LOAD EXTENDED ADDRESS command is issued each time the extended + * address boundary has been crossed */ + if ((CurrentByte & 0x01) || (V2Command == CMD_READ_EEPROM_ISP)) + { + CurrentAddress++; + + if ((V2Command != CMD_READ_EEPROM_ISP) && !(CurrentAddress & 0xFFFF)) + MustLoadExtendedAddress = true; + } + } + + Endpoint_Write_8(STATUS_CMD_OK); + + bool IsEndpointFull = !(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed()); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Ensure last packet is a short packet to terminate the transfer */ + if (IsEndpointFull) + { + Endpoint_WaitUntilReady(); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + Endpoint_WaitUntilReady(); + } +} + +/** Handler for the CMD_CHI_ERASE_ISP command, clearing the target's FLASH memory. */ +void ISPProtocol_ChipErase(void) +{ + struct + { + uint8_t EraseDelayMS; + uint8_t PollMethod; + uint8_t EraseCommandBytes[4]; + } Erase_Chip_Params; + + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&Erase_Chip_Params, sizeof(Erase_Chip_Params), NULL); + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + uint8_t ResponseStatus = STATUS_CMD_OK; + + /* Send the chip erase commands as given by the host to the device */ + for (uint8_t SByte = 0; SByte < sizeof(Erase_Chip_Params.EraseCommandBytes); SByte++) + ISPTarget_SendByte(Erase_Chip_Params.EraseCommandBytes[SByte]); + + /* Use appropriate command completion check as given by the host (delay or busy polling) */ + if (!(Erase_Chip_Params.PollMethod)) + ISPProtocol_DelayMS(Erase_Chip_Params.EraseDelayMS); + else + ResponseStatus = ISPTarget_WaitWhileTargetBusy(); + + Endpoint_Write_8(CMD_CHIP_ERASE_ISP); + Endpoint_Write_8(ResponseStatus); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + +/** Handler for the CMD_READ_FUSE_ISP, CMD_READ_LOCK_ISP, CMD_READ_SIGNATURE_ISP and CMD_READ_OSCCAL commands, + * reading the requested configuration byte from the device. + * + * \param[in] V2Command Issued V2 Protocol command byte from the host + */ +void ISPProtocol_ReadFuseLockSigOSCCAL(uint8_t V2Command) +{ + struct + { + uint8_t RetByte; + uint8_t ReadCommandBytes[4]; + } Read_FuseLockSigOSCCAL_Params; + + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&Read_FuseLockSigOSCCAL_Params, sizeof(Read_FuseLockSigOSCCAL_Params), NULL); + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + uint8_t ResponseBytes[4]; + + /* Send the Fuse or Lock byte read commands as given by the host to the device, store response */ + for (uint8_t RByte = 0; RByte < sizeof(ResponseBytes); RByte++) + ResponseBytes[RByte] = ISPTarget_TransferByte(Read_FuseLockSigOSCCAL_Params.ReadCommandBytes[RByte]); + + Endpoint_Write_8(V2Command); + Endpoint_Write_8(STATUS_CMD_OK); + Endpoint_Write_8(ResponseBytes[Read_FuseLockSigOSCCAL_Params.RetByte - 1]); + Endpoint_Write_8(STATUS_CMD_OK); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + +/** Handler for the CMD_WRITE_FUSE_ISP and CMD_WRITE_LOCK_ISP commands, writing the requested configuration + * byte to the device. + * + * \param[in] V2Command Issued V2 Protocol command byte from the host + */ +void ISPProtocol_WriteFuseLock(uint8_t V2Command) +{ + struct + { + uint8_t WriteCommandBytes[4]; + } Write_FuseLockSig_Params; + + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&Write_FuseLockSig_Params, sizeof(Write_FuseLockSig_Params), NULL); + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + /* Send the Fuse or Lock byte program commands as given by the host to the device */ + for (uint8_t SByte = 0; SByte < sizeof(Write_FuseLockSig_Params.WriteCommandBytes); SByte++) + ISPTarget_SendByte(Write_FuseLockSig_Params.WriteCommandBytes[SByte]); + + Endpoint_Write_8(V2Command); + Endpoint_Write_8(STATUS_CMD_OK); + Endpoint_Write_8(STATUS_CMD_OK); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + +/** Handler for the CMD_SPI_MULTI command, writing and reading arbitrary SPI data to and from the attached device. */ +void ISPProtocol_SPIMulti(void) +{ + struct + { + uint8_t TxBytes; + uint8_t RxBytes; + uint8_t RxStartAddr; + uint8_t TxData[255]; + } SPI_Multi_Params; + + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&SPI_Multi_Params, (sizeof(SPI_Multi_Params) - sizeof(SPI_Multi_Params.TxData)), NULL); + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&SPI_Multi_Params.TxData, SPI_Multi_Params.TxBytes, NULL); + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + Endpoint_Write_8(CMD_SPI_MULTI); + Endpoint_Write_8(STATUS_CMD_OK); + + uint8_t CurrTxPos = 0; + uint8_t CurrRxPos = 0; + + /* Write out bytes to transmit until the start of the bytes to receive is met */ + while (CurrTxPos < SPI_Multi_Params.RxStartAddr) + { + if (CurrTxPos < SPI_Multi_Params.TxBytes) + ISPTarget_SendByte(SPI_Multi_Params.TxData[CurrTxPos]); + else + ISPTarget_SendByte(0); + + CurrTxPos++; + } + + /* Transmit remaining bytes with padding as needed, read in response bytes */ + while (CurrRxPos < SPI_Multi_Params.RxBytes) + { + if (CurrTxPos < SPI_Multi_Params.TxBytes) + Endpoint_Write_8(ISPTarget_TransferByte(SPI_Multi_Params.TxData[CurrTxPos++])); + else + Endpoint_Write_8(ISPTarget_ReceiveByte()); + + /* Check to see if we have filled the endpoint bank and need to send the packet */ + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + Endpoint_WaitUntilReady(); + } + + CurrRxPos++; + } + + Endpoint_Write_8(STATUS_CMD_OK); + + bool IsEndpointFull = !(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed()); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Ensure last packet is a short packet to terminate the transfer */ + if (IsEndpointFull) + { + Endpoint_WaitUntilReady(); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + Endpoint_WaitUntilReady(); + } +} + +/** Blocking delay for a given number of milliseconds. This provides a simple wrapper around + * the avr-libc provided delay function, so that the delay function can be called with a + * constant value (to prevent run-time floating point operations being required). + * + * \param[in] DelayMS Number of milliseconds to delay for + */ +void ISPProtocol_DelayMS(uint8_t DelayMS) +{ + while (DelayMS-- && TimeoutTicksRemaining) + Delay_MS(1); +} + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/ISP/ISPProtocol.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/ISP/ISPProtocol.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..44b339762d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/ISP/ISPProtocol.h @@ -0,0 +1,81 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for ISPProtocol.c. + */ + +#ifndef _ISP_PROTOCOL_ +#define _ISP_PROTOCOL_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <util/delay.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "../V2Protocol.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if ((BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN) || (BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN_REV1)) + #undef ENABLE_ISP_PROTOCOL + + #if !defined(ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL) + #define ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL + #endif + #endif + + /* Macros: */ + /** Mask for the reading or writing of the high byte in a FLASH word when issuing a low-level programming command. */ + #define READ_WRITE_HIGH_BYTE_MASK (1 << 3) + + #define PROG_MODE_PAGED_WRITES_MASK (1 << 0) + #define PROG_MODE_WORD_TIMEDELAY_MASK (1 << 1) + #define PROG_MODE_WORD_VALUE_MASK (1 << 2) + #define PROG_MODE_WORD_READYBUSY_MASK (1 << 3) + #define PROG_MODE_PAGED_TIMEDELAY_MASK (1 << 4) + #define PROG_MODE_PAGED_VALUE_MASK (1 << 5) + #define PROG_MODE_PAGED_READYBUSY_MASK (1 << 6) + #define PROG_MODE_COMMIT_PAGE_MASK (1 << 7) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void ISPProtocol_EnterISPMode(void); + void ISPProtocol_LeaveISPMode(void); + void ISPProtocol_ProgramMemory(const uint8_t V2Command); + void ISPProtocol_ReadMemory(const uint8_t V2Command); + void ISPProtocol_ChipErase(void); + void ISPProtocol_ReadFuseLockSigOSCCAL(const uint8_t V2Command); + void ISPProtocol_WriteFuseLock(const uint8_t V2Command); + void ISPProtocol_SPIMulti(void); + void ISPProtocol_DelayMS(uint8_t DelayMS); +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/ISP/ISPTarget.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/ISP/ISPTarget.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..197b62275d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/ISP/ISPTarget.c @@ -0,0 +1,370 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Target-related functions for the ISP Protocol decoder. + */ + +#include "ISPTarget.h" + +#if defined(ENABLE_ISP_PROTOCOL) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + +/** List of hardware SPI prescaler masks for possible AVRStudio ISP programming speeds. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +static const uint8_t SPIMaskFromSCKDuration[] PROGMEM = +{ +#if (F_CPU == 8000000) + SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_2, // AVRStudio = 8MHz SPI, Actual = 4MHz SPI + SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_2, // AVRStudio = 4MHz SPI, Actual = 4MHz SPI + SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_4, // AVRStudio = 2MHz SPI, Actual = 2MHz SPI + SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_8, // AVRStudio = 1MHz SPI, Actual = 1MHz SPI + SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_16, // AVRStudio = 500KHz SPI, Actual = 500KHz SPI + SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_32, // AVRStudio = 250KHz SPI, Actual = 250KHz SPI + SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_64, // AVRStudio = 125KHz SPI, Actual = 125KHz SPI +#elif (F_CPU == 16000000) + SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_2, // AVRStudio = 8MHz SPI, Actual = 8MHz SPI + SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_4, // AVRStudio = 4MHz SPI, Actual = 4MHz SPI + SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_8, // AVRStudio = 2MHz SPI, Actual = 2MHz SPI + SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_16, // AVRStudio = 1MHz SPI, Actual = 1MHz SPI + SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_32, // AVRStudio = 500KHz SPI, Actual = 500KHz SPI + SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_64, // AVRStudio = 250KHz SPI, Actual = 250KHz SPI + SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_128 // AVRStudio = 125KHz SPI, Actual = 125KHz SPI +#else + #error No SPI prescaler masks for chosen F_CPU speed. +#endif +}; + +/** Lookup table to convert the slower ISP speeds into a compare value for the software SPI driver. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +static const uint16_t TimerCompareFromSCKDuration[] PROGMEM = +{ + TIMER_COMP(96386), TIMER_COMP(89888), TIMER_COMP(84211), TIMER_COMP(79208), TIMER_COMP(74767), + TIMER_COMP(70797), TIMER_COMP(67227), TIMER_COMP(64000), TIMER_COMP(61069), TIMER_COMP(58395), + TIMER_COMP(55945), TIMER_COMP(51613), TIMER_COMP(49690), TIMER_COMP(47905), TIMER_COMP(46243), + TIMER_COMP(43244), TIMER_COMP(41885), TIMER_COMP(39409), TIMER_COMP(38278), TIMER_COMP(36200), + TIMER_COMP(34335), TIMER_COMP(32654), TIMER_COMP(31129), TIMER_COMP(29740), TIMER_COMP(28470), + TIMER_COMP(27304), TIMER_COMP(25724), TIMER_COMP(24768), TIMER_COMP(23461), TIMER_COMP(22285), + TIMER_COMP(21221), TIMER_COMP(20254), TIMER_COMP(19371), TIMER_COMP(18562), TIMER_COMP(17583), + TIMER_COMP(16914), TIMER_COMP(16097), TIMER_COMP(15356), TIMER_COMP(14520), TIMER_COMP(13914), + TIMER_COMP(13224), TIMER_COMP(12599), TIMER_COMP(12031), TIMER_COMP(11511), TIMER_COMP(10944), + TIMER_COMP(10431), TIMER_COMP(9963), TIMER_COMP(9468), TIMER_COMP(9081), TIMER_COMP(8612), + TIMER_COMP(8239), TIMER_COMP(7851), TIMER_COMP(7498), TIMER_COMP(7137), TIMER_COMP(6809), + TIMER_COMP(6478), TIMER_COMP(6178), TIMER_COMP(5879), TIMER_COMP(5607), TIMER_COMP(5359), + TIMER_COMP(5093), TIMER_COMP(4870), TIMER_COMP(4633), TIMER_COMP(4418), TIMER_COMP(4209), + TIMER_COMP(4019), TIMER_COMP(3823), TIMER_COMP(3645), TIMER_COMP(3474), TIMER_COMP(3310), + TIMER_COMP(3161), TIMER_COMP(3011), TIMER_COMP(2869), TIMER_COMP(2734), TIMER_COMP(2611), + TIMER_COMP(2484), TIMER_COMP(2369), TIMER_COMP(2257), TIMER_COMP(2152), TIMER_COMP(2052), + TIMER_COMP(1956), TIMER_COMP(1866), TIMER_COMP(1779), TIMER_COMP(1695), TIMER_COMP(1615), + TIMER_COMP(1539), TIMER_COMP(1468), TIMER_COMP(1398), TIMER_COMP(1333), TIMER_COMP(1271), + TIMER_COMP(1212), TIMER_COMP(1155), TIMER_COMP(1101), TIMER_COMP(1049), TIMER_COMP(1000), + TIMER_COMP(953), TIMER_COMP(909), TIMER_COMP(866), TIMER_COMP(826), TIMER_COMP(787), + TIMER_COMP(750), TIMER_COMP(715), TIMER_COMP(682), TIMER_COMP(650), TIMER_COMP(619), + TIMER_COMP(590), TIMER_COMP(563), TIMER_COMP(536), TIMER_COMP(511), TIMER_COMP(487), + TIMER_COMP(465), TIMER_COMP(443), TIMER_COMP(422), TIMER_COMP(402), TIMER_COMP(384), + TIMER_COMP(366), TIMER_COMP(349), TIMER_COMP(332), TIMER_COMP(317), TIMER_COMP(302), + TIMER_COMP(288), TIMER_COMP(274), TIMER_COMP(261), TIMER_COMP(249), TIMER_COMP(238), + TIMER_COMP(226), TIMER_COMP(216), TIMER_COMP(206), TIMER_COMP(196), TIMER_COMP(187), + TIMER_COMP(178), TIMER_COMP(170), TIMER_COMP(162), TIMER_COMP(154), TIMER_COMP(147), + TIMER_COMP(140), TIMER_COMP(134), TIMER_COMP(128), TIMER_COMP(122), TIMER_COMP(116), + TIMER_COMP(111), TIMER_COMP(105), TIMER_COMP(100), TIMER_COMP(95.4), TIMER_COMP(90.9), + TIMER_COMP(86.6), TIMER_COMP(82.6), TIMER_COMP(78.7), TIMER_COMP(75.0), TIMER_COMP(71.5), + TIMER_COMP(68.2), TIMER_COMP(65.0), TIMER_COMP(61.9), TIMER_COMP(59.0), TIMER_COMP(56.3), + TIMER_COMP(53.6), TIMER_COMP(51.1) +}; + +/** Currently selected SPI driver, either hardware (for fast ISP speeds) or software (for slower ISP speeds). */ +bool HardwareSPIMode = true; + +/** Software SPI data register for sending and receiving */ +static volatile uint8_t SoftSPI_Data; + +/** Number of bits left to transfer in the software SPI driver */ +static volatile uint8_t SoftSPI_BitsRemaining; + + +/** ISR to handle software SPI transmission and reception */ +ISR(TIMER1_COMPA_vect, ISR_BLOCK) +{ + /* Check if rising edge (output next bit) or falling edge (read in next bit) */ + if (!(PINB & (1 << 1))) + { + if (SoftSPI_Data & (1 << 7)) + PORTB |= (1 << 2); + else + PORTB &= ~(1 << 2); + } + else + { + SoftSPI_Data <<= 1; + + if (!(--SoftSPI_BitsRemaining)) + { + TCCR1B = 0; + TIFR1 = (1 << OCF1A); + } + + if (PINB & (1 << 3)) + SoftSPI_Data |= (1 << 0); + } + + /* Fast toggle of PORTB.1 via the PIN register (see datasheet) */ + PINB |= (1 << 1); +} + +/** Initializes the appropriate SPI driver (hardware or software, depending on the selected ISP speed) ready for + * communication with the attached target. + */ +void ISPTarget_EnableTargetISP(void) +{ + uint8_t SCKDuration = V2Params_GetParameterValue(PARAM_SCK_DURATION); + + if (SCKDuration < sizeof(SPIMaskFromSCKDuration)) + { + HardwareSPIMode = true; + + SPI_Init(pgm_read_byte(&SPIMaskFromSCKDuration[SCKDuration]) | SPI_ORDER_MSB_FIRST | + SPI_SCK_LEAD_RISING | SPI_SAMPLE_LEADING | SPI_MODE_MASTER); + } + else + { + HardwareSPIMode = false; + + DDRB |= ((1 << 1) | (1 << 2)); + PORTB |= ((1 << 0) | (1 << 3)); + + ISPTarget_ConfigureSoftwareSPI(SCKDuration); + } +} + +/** Shuts down the current selected SPI driver (hardware or software, depending on the selected ISP speed) so that no + * further communications can occur until the driver is re-initialized. + */ +void ISPTarget_DisableTargetISP(void) +{ + if (HardwareSPIMode) + { + SPI_Disable(); + } + else + { + DDRB &= ~((1 << 1) | (1 << 2)); + PORTB &= ~((1 << 0) | (1 << 3)); + + /* Must re-enable rescue clock once software ISP has exited, as the timer for the rescue clock is + * re-purposed for software SPI */ + ISPTarget_ConfigureRescueClock(); + } +} + +/** Configures the AVR to produce a 4MHz rescue clock out of the OCR1A pin of the AVR, so + * that it can be fed into the XTAL1 pin of an AVR whose fuses have been mis-configured for + * an external clock rather than a crystal. When used, the ISP speed must be 125KHz for this + * functionality to work correctly. + */ +void ISPTarget_ConfigureRescueClock(void) +{ + #if defined(XCK_RESCUE_CLOCK_ENABLE) + /* Configure XCK as an output for the specified AVR model */ + DDRD |= (1 << 5); + + /* Start USART to generate a 4MHz clock on the XCK pin */ + UBRR1 = ((F_CPU / 2 / ISP_RESCUE_CLOCK_SPEED) - 1); + UCSR1B = (1 << TXEN1); + UCSR1C = (1 << UMSEL10) | (1 << UPM11) | (1 << USBS1) | (1 << UCSZ11) | (1 << UCSZ10) | (1 << UCPOL1); + #else + /* Configure OCR1A as an output for the specified AVR model */ + #if defined(USB_SERIES_2_AVR) + DDRC |= (1 << 6); + #else + DDRB |= (1 << 5); + #endif + + /* Start Timer 1 to generate a 4MHz clock on the OCR1A pin */ + TIMSK1 = 0; + TCNT1 = 0; + OCR1A = ((F_CPU / 2 / ISP_RESCUE_CLOCK_SPEED) - 1); + TCCR1A = (1 << COM1A0); + TCCR1B = ((1 << WGM12) | (1 << CS10)); + #endif +} + +/** Configures the AVR's timer ready to produce software SPI for the slower ISP speeds that + * cannot be obtained when using the AVR's hardware SPI module. + * + * \param[in] SCKDuration Duration of the desired software ISP SCK clock + */ +void ISPTarget_ConfigureSoftwareSPI(const uint8_t SCKDuration) +{ + /* Configure Timer 1 for software SPI using the specified SCK duration */ + TIMSK1 = (1 << OCIE1A); + TCNT1 = 0; + OCR1A = pgm_read_word(&TimerCompareFromSCKDuration[SCKDuration - sizeof(SPIMaskFromSCKDuration)]); + TCCR1A = 0; + TCCR1B = 0; +} + +/** Sends and receives a single byte of data to and from the attached target via software SPI. + * + * \param[in] Byte Byte of data to send to the attached target + * + * \return Received byte of data from the attached target + */ +uint8_t ISPTarget_TransferSoftSPIByte(const uint8_t Byte) +{ + SoftSPI_Data = Byte; + SoftSPI_BitsRemaining = 8; + + /* Set initial MOSI pin state according to the byte to be transferred */ + if (SoftSPI_Data & (1 << 7)) + PORTB |= (1 << 2); + else + PORTB &= ~(1 << 2); + + TCNT1 = 0; + TCCR1B = ((1 << WGM12) | (1 << CS11)); + while (SoftSPI_BitsRemaining && TimeoutTicksRemaining); + TCCR1B = 0; + + return SoftSPI_Data; +} + +/** Asserts or deasserts the target's reset line, using the correct polarity as set by the host using a SET PARAM command. + * When not asserted, the line is tristated so as not to interfere with normal device operation. + * + * \param[in] ResetTarget Boolean true when the target should be held in reset, \c false otherwise + */ +void ISPTarget_ChangeTargetResetLine(const bool ResetTarget) +{ + if (ResetTarget) + { + AUX_LINE_DDR |= AUX_LINE_MASK; + + if (!(V2Params_GetParameterValue(PARAM_RESET_POLARITY))) + AUX_LINE_PORT |= AUX_LINE_MASK; + else + AUX_LINE_PORT &= ~AUX_LINE_MASK; + } + else + { + AUX_LINE_DDR &= ~AUX_LINE_MASK; + AUX_LINE_PORT &= ~AUX_LINE_MASK; + } +} + +/** Waits until the target has completed the last operation, by continuously polling the device's + * BUSY flag until it is cleared, or until the command timeout period has expired. + * + * \return V2 Protocol status \ref STATUS_CMD_OK if the no timeout occurred, \ref STATUS_RDY_BSY_TOUT otherwise + */ +uint8_t ISPTarget_WaitWhileTargetBusy(void) +{ + do + { + ISPTarget_SendByte(0xF0); + ISPTarget_SendByte(0x00); + ISPTarget_SendByte(0x00); + } + while ((ISPTarget_ReceiveByte() & 0x01) && TimeoutTicksRemaining); + + return (TimeoutTicksRemaining > 0) ? STATUS_CMD_OK : STATUS_RDY_BSY_TOUT; +} + +/** Sends a low-level LOAD EXTENDED ADDRESS command to the target, for addressing of memory beyond the + * 64KB boundary. This sends the command with the correct address as indicated by the current address + * pointer variable set by the host when a SET ADDRESS command is issued. + */ +void ISPTarget_LoadExtendedAddress(void) +{ + ISPTarget_SendByte(LOAD_EXTENDED_ADDRESS_CMD); + ISPTarget_SendByte(0x00); + ISPTarget_SendByte(CurrentAddress >> 16); + ISPTarget_SendByte(0x00); +} + +/** Waits until the last issued target memory programming command has completed, via the check mode given and using + * the given parameters. + * + * \param[in] ProgrammingMode Programming mode used and completion check to use, a mask of \c PROG_MODE_* constants + * \param[in] PollAddress Memory address to poll for completion if polling check mode used + * \param[in] PollValue Poll value to check against if polling check mode used + * \param[in] DelayMS Milliseconds to delay before returning if delay check mode used + * \param[in] ReadMemCommand Device low-level READ MEMORY command to send if value check mode used + * + * \return V2 Protocol status \ref STATUS_CMD_OK if the no timeout occurred, \ref STATUS_RDY_BSY_TOUT or + * \ref STATUS_CMD_TOUT otherwise + */ +uint8_t ISPTarget_WaitForProgComplete(const uint8_t ProgrammingMode, + const uint16_t PollAddress, + const uint8_t PollValue, + const uint8_t DelayMS, + const uint8_t ReadMemCommand) +{ + uint8_t ProgrammingStatus = STATUS_CMD_OK; + + /* Determine method of Programming Complete check */ + switch (ProgrammingMode & ~(PROG_MODE_PAGED_WRITES_MASK | PROG_MODE_COMMIT_PAGE_MASK)) + { + case PROG_MODE_WORD_TIMEDELAY_MASK: + case PROG_MODE_PAGED_TIMEDELAY_MASK: + ISPProtocol_DelayMS(DelayMS); + break; + case PROG_MODE_WORD_VALUE_MASK: + case PROG_MODE_PAGED_VALUE_MASK: + do + { + ISPTarget_SendByte(ReadMemCommand); + ISPTarget_SendByte(PollAddress >> 8); + ISPTarget_SendByte(PollAddress & 0xFF); + } + while ((ISPTarget_TransferByte(0x00) == PollValue) && TimeoutTicksRemaining); + + if (!(TimeoutTicksRemaining)) + ProgrammingStatus = STATUS_CMD_TOUT; + + break; + case PROG_MODE_WORD_READYBUSY_MASK: + case PROG_MODE_PAGED_READYBUSY_MASK: + ProgrammingStatus = ISPTarget_WaitWhileTargetBusy(); + break; + } + + /* Program complete - reset timeout */ + TimeoutTicksRemaining = COMMAND_TIMEOUT_TICKS; + + return ProgrammingStatus; +} + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/ISP/ISPTarget.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/ISP/ISPTarget.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5f32f51940 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/ISP/ISPTarget.h @@ -0,0 +1,147 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for ISPTarget.c. + */ + +#ifndef _ISP_TARGET_ +#define _ISP_TARGET_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <util/delay.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/SPI.h> + + #include "../V2Protocol.h" + #include "ISPProtocol.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if ((BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN) || (BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN_REV1)) + #undef ENABLE_ISP_PROTOCOL + + #if !defined(ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL) + #define ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL + #endif + #endif + + /* Macros: */ + /** Low level device command to issue an extended FLASH address, for devices with over 128KB of FLASH. */ + #define LOAD_EXTENDED_ADDRESS_CMD 0x4D + + /** Macro to convert an ISP frequency to a number of timer clock cycles for the software SPI driver. */ + #define TIMER_COMP(freq) (((F_CPU / 8) / 2 / freq) - 1) + + /** ISP rescue clock speed in Hz, for clocking targets with incorrectly set fuses. */ + #define ISP_RESCUE_CLOCK_SPEED 4000000 + + /* External Variables: */ + extern bool HardwareSPIMode; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void ISPTarget_EnableTargetISP(void); + void ISPTarget_DisableTargetISP(void); + void ISPTarget_ConfigureRescueClock(void); + void ISPTarget_ConfigureSoftwareSPI(const uint8_t SCKDuration); + uint8_t ISPTarget_TransferSoftSPIByte(const uint8_t Byte); + void ISPTarget_ChangeTargetResetLine(const bool ResetTarget); + uint8_t ISPTarget_WaitWhileTargetBusy(void); + void ISPTarget_LoadExtendedAddress(void); + uint8_t ISPTarget_WaitForProgComplete(const uint8_t ProgrammingMode, + const uint16_t PollAddress, + const uint8_t PollValue, + const uint8_t DelayMS, + const uint8_t ReadMemCommand); + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Sends a byte of ISP data to the attached target, using the appropriate SPI hardware or + * software routines depending on the selected ISP speed. + * + * \param[in] Byte Byte of data to send to the attached target + */ + static inline void ISPTarget_SendByte(const uint8_t Byte) + { + if (HardwareSPIMode) + SPI_SendByte(Byte); + else + ISPTarget_TransferSoftSPIByte(Byte); + } + + /** Receives a byte of ISP data from the attached target, using the appropriate + * SPI hardware or software routines depending on the selected ISP speed. + * + * \return Received byte of data from the attached target + */ + static inline uint8_t ISPTarget_ReceiveByte(void) + { + uint8_t ReceivedByte; + + if (HardwareSPIMode) + ReceivedByte = SPI_ReceiveByte(); + else + ReceivedByte = ISPTarget_TransferSoftSPIByte(0x00); + + #if defined(INVERTED_ISP_MISO) + return ~ReceivedByte; + #else + return ReceivedByte; + #endif + } + + /** Sends and receives a byte of ISP data to and from the attached target, using the + * appropriate SPI hardware or software routines depending on the selected ISP speed. + * + * \param[in] Byte Byte of data to send to the attached target + * + * \return Received byte of data from the attached target + */ + static inline uint8_t ISPTarget_TransferByte(const uint8_t Byte) + { + uint8_t ReceivedByte; + + if (HardwareSPIMode) + ReceivedByte = SPI_TransferByte(Byte); + else + ReceivedByte = ISPTarget_TransferSoftSPIByte(Byte); + + #if defined(INVERTED_ISP_MISO) + return ~ReceivedByte; + #else + return ReceivedByte; + #endif + } + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/V2Protocol.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/V2Protocol.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..fd64c5a1e8 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/V2Protocol.c @@ -0,0 +1,267 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * V2Protocol handler, to process V2 Protocol commands used in Atmel programmer devices. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_V2PROTOCOL_C +#include "V2Protocol.h" + +/** Current memory address for FLASH/EEPROM memory read/write commands */ +uint32_t CurrentAddress; + +/** Flag to indicate that the next read/write operation must update the device's current extended FLASH address */ +bool MustLoadExtendedAddress; + + +/** ISR to manage timeouts whilst processing a V2Protocol command */ +ISR(TIMER0_COMPA_vect, ISR_NOBLOCK) +{ + if (TimeoutTicksRemaining) + TimeoutTicksRemaining--; + else + TCCR0B = 0; +} + +/** Initializes the hardware and software associated with the V2 protocol command handling. */ +void V2Protocol_Init(void) +{ + #if defined(ADC) && !defined(NO_VTARGET_DETECT) + /* Initialize the ADC converter for VTARGET level detection on supported AVR models */ + ADC_Init(ADC_FREE_RUNNING | ADC_PRESCALE_128); + ADC_SetupChannel(VTARGET_ADC_CHANNEL); + ADC_StartReading(VTARGET_REF_MASK | ADC_RIGHT_ADJUSTED | VTARGET_ADC_CHANNEL_MASK); + #endif + + /* Timeout timer initialization (~10ms period) */ + OCR0A = (((F_CPU / 1024) / 100) - 1); + TCCR0A = (1 << WGM01); + TIMSK0 = (1 << OCIE0A); + + V2Params_LoadNonVolatileParamValues(); + + #if defined(ENABLE_ISP_PROTOCOL) + ISPTarget_ConfigureRescueClock(); + #endif +} + +/** Master V2 Protocol packet handler, for received V2 Protocol packets from a connected host. + * This routine decodes the issued command and passes off the handling of the command to the + * appropriate function. + */ +void V2Protocol_ProcessCommand(void) +{ + uint8_t V2Command = Endpoint_Read_8(); + + /* Reset timeout counter duration and start the timer */ + TimeoutTicksRemaining = COMMAND_TIMEOUT_TICKS; + TCCR0B = ((1 << CS02) | (1 << CS00)); + + switch (V2Command) + { + case CMD_SIGN_ON: + V2Protocol_SignOn(); + break; + case CMD_SET_PARAMETER: + case CMD_GET_PARAMETER: + V2Protocol_GetSetParam(V2Command); + break; + case CMD_LOAD_ADDRESS: + V2Protocol_LoadAddress(); + break; + case CMD_RESET_PROTECTION: + V2Protocol_ResetProtection(); + break; +#if defined(ENABLE_ISP_PROTOCOL) + case CMD_ENTER_PROGMODE_ISP: + ISPProtocol_EnterISPMode(); + break; + case CMD_LEAVE_PROGMODE_ISP: + ISPProtocol_LeaveISPMode(); + break; + case CMD_PROGRAM_FLASH_ISP: + case CMD_PROGRAM_EEPROM_ISP: + ISPProtocol_ProgramMemory(V2Command); + break; + case CMD_READ_FLASH_ISP: + case CMD_READ_EEPROM_ISP: + ISPProtocol_ReadMemory(V2Command); + break; + case CMD_CHIP_ERASE_ISP: + ISPProtocol_ChipErase(); + break; + case CMD_READ_FUSE_ISP: + case CMD_READ_LOCK_ISP: + case CMD_READ_SIGNATURE_ISP: + case CMD_READ_OSCCAL_ISP: + ISPProtocol_ReadFuseLockSigOSCCAL(V2Command); + break; + case CMD_PROGRAM_FUSE_ISP: + case CMD_PROGRAM_LOCK_ISP: + ISPProtocol_WriteFuseLock(V2Command); + break; + case CMD_SPI_MULTI: + ISPProtocol_SPIMulti(); + break; +#endif +#if defined(ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL) + case CMD_XPROG_SETMODE: + XPROGProtocol_SetMode(); + break; + case CMD_XPROG: + XPROGProtocol_Command(); + break; +#endif + default: + V2Protocol_UnknownCommand(V2Command); + break; + } + + /* Disable the timeout management timer */ + TCCR0B = 0; + + Endpoint_WaitUntilReady(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_OUT_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT); +} + +/** Handler for unknown V2 protocol commands. This discards all sent data and returns a + * STATUS_CMD_UNKNOWN status back to the host. + * + * \param[in] V2Command Issued V2 Protocol command byte from the host + */ +static void V2Protocol_UnknownCommand(const uint8_t V2Command) +{ + /* Discard all incoming data */ + while (Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint() == AVRISP_DATA_EPSIZE) + { + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_WaitUntilReady(); + } + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + Endpoint_Write_8(V2Command); + Endpoint_Write_8(STATUS_CMD_UNKNOWN); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + +/** Handler for the CMD_SIGN_ON command, returning the programmer ID string to the host. */ +static void V2Protocol_SignOn(void) +{ + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + Endpoint_Write_8(CMD_SIGN_ON); + Endpoint_Write_8(STATUS_CMD_OK); + Endpoint_Write_8(sizeof(PROGRAMMER_ID) - 1); + Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(PROGRAMMER_ID, (sizeof(PROGRAMMER_ID) - 1), NULL); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + +/** Handler for the CMD_RESET_PROTECTION command, implemented as a dummy ACK function as + * no target short-circuit protection is currently implemented. + */ +static void V2Protocol_ResetProtection(void) +{ + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + Endpoint_Write_8(CMD_RESET_PROTECTION); + Endpoint_Write_8(STATUS_CMD_OK); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + + +/** Handler for the CMD_SET_PARAMETER and CMD_GET_PARAMETER commands from the host, setting or + * getting a device parameter's value from the parameter table. + * + * \param[in] V2Command Issued V2 Protocol command byte from the host + */ +static void V2Protocol_GetSetParam(const uint8_t V2Command) +{ + uint8_t ParamID = Endpoint_Read_8(); + uint8_t ParamValue; + + if (V2Command == CMD_SET_PARAMETER) + ParamValue = Endpoint_Read_8(); + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + Endpoint_Write_8(V2Command); + + uint8_t ParamPrivs = V2Params_GetParameterPrivileges(ParamID); + + if ((V2Command == CMD_SET_PARAMETER) && (ParamPrivs & PARAM_PRIV_WRITE)) + { + Endpoint_Write_8(STATUS_CMD_OK); + V2Params_SetParameterValue(ParamID, ParamValue); + } + else if ((V2Command == CMD_GET_PARAMETER) && (ParamPrivs & PARAM_PRIV_READ)) + { + Endpoint_Write_8(STATUS_CMD_OK); + Endpoint_Write_8(V2Params_GetParameterValue(ParamID)); + } + else + { + Endpoint_Write_8(STATUS_CMD_FAILED); + } + + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + +/** Handler for the CMD_LOAD_ADDRESS command, loading the given device address into a + * global storage variable for later use, and issuing LOAD EXTENDED ADDRESS commands + * to the attached device as required. + */ +static void V2Protocol_LoadAddress(void) +{ + Endpoint_Read_Stream_BE(&CurrentAddress, sizeof(CurrentAddress), NULL); + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + if (CurrentAddress & (1UL << 31)) + MustLoadExtendedAddress = true; + + Endpoint_Write_8(CMD_LOAD_ADDRESS); + Endpoint_Write_8(STATUS_CMD_OK); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/V2Protocol.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/V2Protocol.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0f447ba4b9 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/V2Protocol.h @@ -0,0 +1,105 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for V2Protocol.c. + */ + +#ifndef _V2_PROTOCOL_ +#define _V2_PROTOCOL_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "../AVRISPDescriptors.h" + #include "V2ProtocolConstants.h" + #include "V2ProtocolParams.h" + #include "ISP/ISPProtocol.h" + #include "XPROG/XPROGProtocol.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if ((BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN) || (BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN_REV1)) + #undef ENABLE_ISP_PROTOCOL + + #if !defined(ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL) + #define ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL + #endif + #endif + + #if defined(USB_SERIES_4_AVR) && ((VTARGET_ADC_CHANNEL == 2) || (VTARGET_ADC_CHANNEL == 3)) && !defined(NO_VTARGET_DETECT) + #error The U4 AVR chips do not contain ADC channels 2 or 3. Please change VTARGET_ADC_CHANNEL or define NO_VTARGET_DETECT in the makefile. + #endif + + #if defined(VTARGET_USE_INTERNAL_REF) + #undef VTARGET_REF_VOLTS + #define VTARGET_REF_VOLTS 2.56 + + #define VTARGET_REF_MASK ADC_REFERENCE_INT2560MV + #else + #define VTARGET_REF_MASK ADC_REFERENCE_AVCC + #endif + + /* Macros: */ + /** Programmer ID string, returned to the host during the CMD_SIGN_ON command processing. */ + #define PROGRAMMER_ID "AVRISP_MK2" + + /** Timeout period for each issued command from the host before it is aborted (in 10ms ticks). */ + #define COMMAND_TIMEOUT_TICKS 100 + + /** Command timeout ticks remaining counter, GPIOR for speed. */ + #define TimeoutTicksRemaining GPIOR1 + + /** MUX mask for the VTARGET ADC channel number. */ + #define VTARGET_ADC_CHANNEL_MASK ADC_GET_CHANNEL_MASK(VTARGET_ADC_CHANNEL) + + /* External Variables: */ + extern uint32_t CurrentAddress; + extern bool MustLoadExtendedAddress; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void V2Protocol_Init(void); + void V2Protocol_ProcessCommand(void); + + #if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_V2PROTOCOL_C) + static void V2Protocol_UnknownCommand(const uint8_t V2Command); + static void V2Protocol_SignOn(void); + static void V2Protocol_GetSetParam(const uint8_t V2Command); + static void V2Protocol_ResetProtection(void); + static void V2Protocol_LoadAddress(void); + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/V2ProtocolConstants.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/V2ProtocolConstants.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..121eae7f3f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/V2ProtocolConstants.h @@ -0,0 +1,90 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Macros for the V2 Protocol Packet Commands and Responses. + */ + +#ifndef _V2_PROTOCOL_CONSTANTS_ +#define _V2_PROTOCOL_CONSTANTS_ + + /* Macros: */ + #define CMD_SIGN_ON 0x01 + #define CMD_SET_PARAMETER 0x02 + #define CMD_GET_PARAMETER 0x03 + #define CMD_OSCCAL 0x05 + #define CMD_LOAD_ADDRESS 0x06 + #define CMD_FIRMWARE_UPGRADE 0x07 + #define CMD_RESET_PROTECTION 0x0A + #define CMD_ENTER_PROGMODE_ISP 0x10 + #define CMD_LEAVE_PROGMODE_ISP 0x11 + #define CMD_CHIP_ERASE_ISP 0x12 + #define CMD_PROGRAM_FLASH_ISP 0x13 + #define CMD_READ_FLASH_ISP 0x14 + #define CMD_PROGRAM_EEPROM_ISP 0x15 + #define CMD_READ_EEPROM_ISP 0x16 + #define CMD_PROGRAM_FUSE_ISP 0x17 + #define CMD_READ_FUSE_ISP 0x18 + #define CMD_PROGRAM_LOCK_ISP 0x19 + #define CMD_READ_LOCK_ISP 0x1A + #define CMD_READ_SIGNATURE_ISP 0x1B + #define CMD_READ_OSCCAL_ISP 0x1C + #define CMD_SPI_MULTI 0x1D + #define CMD_XPROG 0x50 + #define CMD_XPROG_SETMODE 0x51 + + #define STATUS_CMD_OK 0x00 + #define STATUS_CMD_TOUT 0x80 + #define STATUS_RDY_BSY_TOUT 0x81 + #define STATUS_SET_PARAM_MISSING 0x82 + #define STATUS_CMD_FAILED 0xC0 + #define STATUS_CMD_UNKNOWN 0xC9 + #define STATUS_CMD_ILLEGAL_PARAM 0xCA + #define STATUS_ISP_READY 0x00 + #define STATUS_CONN_FAIL_MOSI 0x01 + #define STATUS_CONN_FAIL_RST 0x02 + #define STATUS_CONN_FAIL_SCK 0x04 + #define STATUS_TGT_NOT_DETECTED 0x10 + #define STATUS_TGT_REVERSE_INSERTED 0x20 + + #define PARAM_BUILD_NUMBER_LOW 0x80 + #define PARAM_BUILD_NUMBER_HIGH 0x81 + #define PARAM_HW_VER 0x90 + #define PARAM_SW_MAJOR 0x91 + #define PARAM_SW_MINOR 0x92 + #define PARAM_VTARGET 0x94 + #define PARAM_SCK_DURATION 0x98 + #define PARAM_RESET_POLARITY 0x9E + #define PARAM_STATUS_TGT_CONN 0xA1 + #define PARAM_DISCHARGEDELAY 0xA4 + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/V2ProtocolParams.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/V2ProtocolParams.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0b33c212f8 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/V2ProtocolParams.c @@ -0,0 +1,207 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * V2Protocol parameter handler, to process V2 Protocol device parameters. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_V2PROTOCOL_PARAMS_C +#include "V2ProtocolParams.h" + +/* Non-Volatile Parameter Values for EEPROM storage */ +static uint8_t EEMEM EEPROM_Reset_Polarity = 0x01; + +/* Non-Volatile Parameter Values for EEPROM storage */ +static uint8_t EEMEM EEPROM_SCK_Duration = 0x06; + +/* Volatile Parameter Values for RAM storage */ +static ParameterItem_t ParameterTable[] = + { + { .ParamID = PARAM_BUILD_NUMBER_LOW, + .ParamPrivileges = PARAM_PRIV_READ, + .ParamValue = 0 }, + + { .ParamID = PARAM_BUILD_NUMBER_HIGH, + .ParamPrivileges = PARAM_PRIV_READ, + .ParamValue = 0 }, + + { .ParamID = PARAM_HW_VER, + .ParamPrivileges = PARAM_PRIV_READ, + .ParamValue = 0x00 }, + + { .ParamID = PARAM_SW_MAJOR, + .ParamPrivileges = PARAM_PRIV_READ, + .ParamValue = 0x01 }, + + { .ParamID = PARAM_SW_MINOR, + .ParamPrivileges = PARAM_PRIV_READ, + .ParamValue = FIRMWARE_VERSION_MINOR }, + + { .ParamID = PARAM_VTARGET, + .ParamPrivileges = PARAM_PRIV_READ, + .ParamValue = (uint8_t)(3.3 * 10) }, + + { .ParamID = PARAM_SCK_DURATION, + .ParamPrivileges = PARAM_PRIV_READ | PARAM_PRIV_WRITE, + .ParamValue = 6 }, + + { .ParamID = PARAM_RESET_POLARITY, + .ParamPrivileges = PARAM_PRIV_READ | PARAM_PRIV_WRITE, + .ParamValue = 0x01 }, + + { .ParamID = PARAM_STATUS_TGT_CONN, + .ParamPrivileges = PARAM_PRIV_READ, + .ParamValue = STATUS_ISP_READY }, + + { .ParamID = PARAM_DISCHARGEDELAY, + .ParamPrivileges = PARAM_PRIV_READ | PARAM_PRIV_WRITE, + .ParamValue = 0x00 }, + }; + + +/** Loads saved non-volatile parameter values from the EEPROM into the parameter table, as needed. */ +void V2Params_LoadNonVolatileParamValues(void) +{ + /* Read parameter values that are stored in non-volatile EEPROM */ + uint8_t ResetPolarity = eeprom_read_byte(&EEPROM_Reset_Polarity); + uint8_t SCKDuration = eeprom_read_byte(&EEPROM_SCK_Duration); + + /* Update current parameter table if the EEPROM contents was not blank */ + if (ResetPolarity != 0xFF) + V2Params_GetParamFromTable(PARAM_RESET_POLARITY)->ParamValue = ResetPolarity; + + /* Update current parameter table if the EEPROM contents was not blank */ + if (SCKDuration != 0xFF) + V2Params_GetParamFromTable(PARAM_SCK_DURATION)->ParamValue = SCKDuration; +} + +/** Updates any parameter values that are sourced from hardware rather than explicitly set by the host, such as + * VTARGET levels from the ADC on supported AVR models. + */ +void V2Params_UpdateParamValues(void) +{ + #if (defined(ADC) && !defined(NO_VTARGET_DETECT)) + /* Update VTARGET parameter with the latest ADC conversion of VTARGET on supported AVR models */ + V2Params_GetParamFromTable(PARAM_VTARGET)->ParamValue = (((uint16_t)(VTARGET_REF_VOLTS * 10 * VTARGET_SCALE_FACTOR) * ADC_GetResult()) / 1024); + #endif +} + +/** Retrieves the host PC read/write privileges for a given parameter in the parameter table. This should + * be called before calls to \ref V2Params_GetParameterValue() or \ref V2Params_SetParameterValue() when + * getting or setting parameter values in response to requests from the host. + * + * \param[in] ParamID Parameter ID whose privileges are to be retrieved from the table + * + * \return Privileges for the requested parameter, as a mask of \c PARAM_PRIV_* masks + */ +uint8_t V2Params_GetParameterPrivileges(const uint8_t ParamID) +{ + ParameterItem_t* const ParamInfo = V2Params_GetParamFromTable(ParamID); + + if (ParamInfo == NULL) + return 0; + + return ParamInfo->ParamPrivileges; +} + +/** Retrieves the current value for a given parameter in the parameter table. + * + * \note This function does not first check for read privileges - if the value is being sent to the host via a + * GET PARAM command, \ref V2Params_GetParameterPrivileges() should be called first to ensure that the + * parameter is host-readable. + * + * \param[in] ParamID Parameter ID whose value is to be retrieved from the table + * + * \return Current value of the parameter in the table, or 0 if not found + */ +uint8_t V2Params_GetParameterValue(const uint8_t ParamID) +{ + ParameterItem_t* const ParamInfo = V2Params_GetParamFromTable(ParamID); + + if (ParamInfo == NULL) + return 0; + + return ParamInfo->ParamValue; +} + +/** Sets the value for a given parameter in the parameter table. + * + * \note This function does not first check for write privileges - if the value is being sourced from the host + * via a SET PARAM command, \ref V2Params_GetParameterPrivileges() should be called first to ensure that the + * parameter is host-writable. + * + * \param[in] ParamID Parameter ID whose value is to be set in the table + * \param[in] Value New value to set the parameter to + * + * \return Pointer to the associated parameter information from the parameter table if found, NULL otherwise + */ +void V2Params_SetParameterValue(const uint8_t ParamID, + const uint8_t Value) +{ + ParameterItem_t* const ParamInfo = V2Params_GetParamFromTable(ParamID); + + if (ParamInfo == NULL) + return; + + ParamInfo->ParamValue = Value; + + /* The target RESET line polarity is a non-volatile parameter, save to EEPROM when changed */ + if (ParamID == PARAM_RESET_POLARITY) + eeprom_update_byte(&EEPROM_Reset_Polarity, Value); + + /* The target SCK line period is a non-volatile parameter, save to EEPROM when changed */ + if (ParamID == PARAM_SCK_DURATION) + eeprom_update_byte(&EEPROM_SCK_Duration, Value); +} + +/** Retrieves a parameter entry (including ID, value and privileges) from the parameter table that matches the given + * parameter ID. + * + * \param[in] ParamID Parameter ID to find in the table + * + * \return Pointer to the associated parameter information from the parameter table if found, NULL otherwise + */ +static ParameterItem_t* const V2Params_GetParamFromTable(const uint8_t ParamID) +{ + ParameterItem_t* CurrTableItem = ParameterTable; + + /* Find the parameter in the parameter table if present */ + for (uint8_t TableIndex = 0; TableIndex < TABLE_PARAM_COUNT; TableIndex++) + { + if (ParamID == CurrTableItem->ParamID) + return CurrTableItem; + + CurrTableItem++; + } + + return NULL; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/V2ProtocolParams.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/V2ProtocolParams.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b195f67c55 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/V2ProtocolParams.h @@ -0,0 +1,91 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for V2ProtocolParams.c. + */ + +#ifndef _V2_PROTOCOL_PARAMS_ +#define _V2_PROTOCOL_PARAMS_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/eeprom.h> + + #if defined(ADC) + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/ADC.h> + #endif + + #include "V2Protocol.h" + #include "V2ProtocolConstants.h" + #include "ISP/ISPTarget.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Parameter privilege mask to allow the host PC to read the parameter's value. */ + #define PARAM_PRIV_READ (1 << 0) + + /** Parameter privilege mask to allow the host PC to change the parameter's value. */ + #define PARAM_PRIV_WRITE (1 << 1) + + /** Total number of parameters in the parameter table */ + #define TABLE_PARAM_COUNT (sizeof(ParameterTable) / sizeof(ParameterTable[0])) + + #if (!defined(FIRMWARE_VERSION_MINOR) || defined(__DOXYGEN__)) + /** Minor firmware version, reported to the host on request; must match the version + * the host is expecting, or it (may) reject further communications with the programmer. */ + #define FIRMWARE_VERSION_MINOR 0x18 + #endif + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for a parameter table entry indicating a PC readable or writable device parameter. */ + typedef struct + { + const uint8_t ParamID; /**< Parameter ID number to uniquely identify the parameter within the device */ + const uint8_t ParamPrivileges; /**< Parameter privileges to allow the host to read or write the parameter's value */ + uint8_t ParamValue; /**< Current parameter's value within the device */ + } ParameterItem_t; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void V2Params_LoadNonVolatileParamValues(void); + void V2Params_UpdateParamValues(void); + + uint8_t V2Params_GetParameterPrivileges(const uint8_t ParamID); + uint8_t V2Params_GetParameterValue(const uint8_t ParamID); + void V2Params_SetParameterValue(const uint8_t ParamID, + const uint8_t Value); + + #if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_V2PROTOCOL_PARAMS_C) + static ParameterItem_t* const V2Params_GetParamFromTable(const uint8_t ParamID); + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/TINYNVM.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/TINYNVM.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..22eb7d74cb --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/TINYNVM.c @@ -0,0 +1,274 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Target-related functions for the TINY target's NVM module. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_TINYNVM_C +#include "TINYNVM.h" + +#if defined(ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + +/** Sends the given pointer address to the target's TPI pointer register */ +static void TINYNVM_SendPointerAddress(const uint16_t AbsoluteAddress) +{ + /* Send the given 16-bit address to the target, LSB first */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(TPI_CMD_SSTPR | 0); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(AbsoluteAddress & 0xFF); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(TPI_CMD_SSTPR | 1); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(AbsoluteAddress >> 8); +} + +/** Sends a SIN command to the target with the specified I/O address, ready for the data byte to be written. + * + * \param[in] Address 6-bit I/O address to write to in the target's I/O memory space + */ +static void TINYNVM_SendReadNVMRegister(const uint8_t Address) +{ + /* The TPI command for reading from the I/O space uses strange addressing, where the I/O address's upper + * two bits of the 6-bit address are shifted left once - use function to reduce code size */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(TPI_CMD_SIN(Address)); +} + +/** Sends a SOUT command to the target with the specified I/O address, ready for the data byte to be read. + * + * \param[in] Address 6-bit I/O address to read from in the target's I/O memory space + */ +static void TINYNVM_SendWriteNVMRegister(const uint8_t Address) +{ + /* The TPI command for reading from the I/O space uses strange addressing, where the I/O address's upper + * two bits of the 6-bit address are shifted left once - use function to reduce code size */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(TPI_CMD_SOUT(Address)); +} + +/** Busy-waits while the NVM controller is busy performing a NVM operation, such as a FLASH page read. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the NVM controller became ready within the timeout period, \c false otherwise + */ +bool TINYNVM_WaitWhileNVMBusBusy(void) +{ + /* Poll the STATUS register to check to see if NVM access has been enabled */ + for (;;) + { + /* Send the SLDCS command to read the TPI STATUS register to see the NVM bus is active */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(TPI_CMD_SLDCS(TPI_REG_STATUS)); + + uint8_t StatusRegister = XPROGTarget_ReceiveByte(); + + /* We might have timed out waiting for the status register read response, check here */ + if (!(TimeoutTicksRemaining)) + return false; + + /* Check the status register read response to see if the NVM bus is enabled */ + if (StatusRegister & TPI_STATUS_NVM) + return true; + } +} + +/** Waits while the target's NVM controller is busy performing an operation, exiting if the + * timeout period expires. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the NVM controller became ready within the timeout period, \c false otherwise + */ +bool TINYNVM_WaitWhileNVMControllerBusy(void) +{ + /* Poll the STATUS register to check to see if NVM access has been enabled */ + for (;;) + { + /* Send the SIN command to read the TPI STATUS register to see the NVM bus is busy */ + TINYNVM_SendReadNVMRegister(XPROG_Param_NVMCSRRegAddr); + + uint8_t StatusRegister = XPROGTarget_ReceiveByte(); + + /* We might have timed out waiting for the status register read response, check here */ + if (!(TimeoutTicksRemaining)) + return false; + + /* Check to see if the BUSY flag is still set */ + if (!(StatusRegister & (1 << 7))) + return true; + } +} + +/** Enables the physical TPI interface on the target and enables access to the internal NVM controller. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the TPI interface was enabled successfully, \c false otherwise + */ +bool TINYNVM_EnableTPI(void) +{ + /* Enable TPI programming mode with the attached target */ + XPROGTarget_EnableTargetTPI(); + + /* Lower direction change guard time to 32 USART bits */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(TPI_CMD_SSTCS(TPI_REG_CTRL)); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(0x02); + + /* Enable access to the XPROG NVM bus by sending the documented NVM access key to the device */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(TPI_CMD_SKEY); + for (uint8_t i = sizeof(TPI_NVMENABLE_KEY); i > 0; i--) + XPROGTarget_SendByte(TPI_NVMENABLE_KEY[i - 1]); + + /* Wait until the NVM bus becomes active */ + return TINYNVM_WaitWhileNVMBusBusy(); +} + +/** Removes access to the target's NVM controller and physically disables the target's physical TPI interface. */ +void TINYNVM_DisableTPI(void) +{ + TINYNVM_WaitWhileNVMBusBusy(); + + do + { + /* Clear the NVMEN bit in the TPI STATUS register to disable TPI mode */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(TPI_CMD_SSTCS(TPI_REG_STATUS)); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(0x00); + + /* Read back the STATUS register, check to see if it took effect */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(TPI_CMD_SLDCS(TPI_REG_STATUS)); + } while (XPROGTarget_ReceiveByte() != 0x00); + + XPROGTarget_DisableTargetTPI(); +} + +/** Reads memory from the target's memory spaces. + * + * \param[in] ReadAddress Start address to read from within the target's address space + * \param[out] ReadBuffer Buffer to store read data into + * \param[in] ReadSize Length of the data to read from the device + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command sequence complete successfully + */ +bool TINYNVM_ReadMemory(const uint16_t ReadAddress, + uint8_t* ReadBuffer, + uint16_t ReadSize) +{ + /* Wait until the NVM controller is no longer busy */ + if (!(TINYNVM_WaitWhileNVMControllerBusy())) + return false; + + /* Set the NVM control register to the NO OP command for memory reading */ + TINYNVM_SendWriteNVMRegister(XPROG_Param_NVMCMDRegAddr); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(TINY_NVM_CMD_NOOP); + + /* Send the address of the location to read from */ + TINYNVM_SendPointerAddress(ReadAddress); + + while (ReadSize-- && TimeoutTicksRemaining) + { + /* Read the byte of data from the target */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(TPI_CMD_SLD(TPI_POINTER_INDIRECT_PI)); + *(ReadBuffer++) = XPROGTarget_ReceiveByte(); + } + + return (TimeoutTicksRemaining > 0); +} + +/** Writes word addressed memory to the target's memory spaces. + * + * \param[in] WriteAddress Start address to write to within the target's address space + * \param[in] WriteBuffer Buffer to source data from + * \param[in] WriteLength Total number of bytes to write to the device (must be an integer multiple of 2) + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command sequence complete successfully + */ +bool TINYNVM_WriteMemory(const uint16_t WriteAddress, + uint8_t* WriteBuffer, + uint16_t WriteLength) +{ + /* Wait until the NVM controller is no longer busy */ + if (!(TINYNVM_WaitWhileNVMControllerBusy())) + return false; + + /* Must have an integer number of words to write - if extra byte, word-align via a dummy high byte */ + if (WriteLength & 0x01) + WriteBuffer[WriteLength++] = 0xFF; + + /* Set the NVM control register to the WORD WRITE command for memory writing */ + TINYNVM_SendWriteNVMRegister(XPROG_Param_NVMCMDRegAddr); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(TINY_NVM_CMD_WORDWRITE); + + /* Send the address of the location to write to */ + TINYNVM_SendPointerAddress(WriteAddress); + + while (WriteLength) + { + /* Wait until the NVM controller is no longer busy */ + if (!(TINYNVM_WaitWhileNVMControllerBusy())) + return false; + + /* Write the low byte of data to the target */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(TPI_CMD_SST(TPI_POINTER_INDIRECT_PI)); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(*(WriteBuffer++)); + + /* Write the high byte of data to the target */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(TPI_CMD_SST(TPI_POINTER_INDIRECT_PI)); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(*(WriteBuffer++)); + + /* Need to decrement the write length twice, since we wrote a whole two-byte word */ + WriteLength -= 2; + } + + return true; +} + +/** Erases the target's memory space. + * + * \param[in] EraseCommand NVM erase command to send to the device + * \param[in] Address Address inside the memory space to erase + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command sequence complete successfully + */ +bool TINYNVM_EraseMemory(const uint8_t EraseCommand, + const uint16_t Address) +{ + /* Wait until the NVM controller is no longer busy */ + if (!(TINYNVM_WaitWhileNVMControllerBusy())) + return false; + + /* Set the NVM control register to the target memory erase command */ + TINYNVM_SendWriteNVMRegister(XPROG_Param_NVMCMDRegAddr); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(EraseCommand); + + /* Write to a high byte location within the target address space to start the erase process */ + TINYNVM_SendPointerAddress(Address | 0x0001); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(TPI_CMD_SST(TPI_POINTER_INDIRECT)); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(0x00); + + /* Wait until the NVM controller is no longer busy */ + if (!(TINYNVM_WaitWhileNVMControllerBusy())) + return false; + + return true; +} + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/TINYNVM.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/TINYNVM.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..61389bb455 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/TINYNVM.h @@ -0,0 +1,86 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for TINYNVM.c. + */ + +#ifndef _TINY_NVM_ +#define _TINY_NVM_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdbool.h> + + #include <LUFA/Common/Common.h> + + #include "XPROGProtocol.h" + #include "XPROGTarget.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if ((BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN) || (BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN_REV1)) + #undef ENABLE_ISP_PROTOCOL + + #if !defined(ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL) + #define ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL + #endif + #endif + + /* Defines: */ + #define TINY_NVM_CMD_NOOP 0x00 + #define TINY_NVM_CMD_CHIPERASE 0x10 + #define TINY_NVM_CMD_SECTIONERASE 0x14 + #define TINY_NVM_CMD_WORDWRITE 0x1D + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + bool TINYNVM_WaitWhileNVMBusBusy(void); + bool TINYNVM_WaitWhileNVMControllerBusy(void); + bool TINYNVM_EnableTPI(void); + void TINYNVM_DisableTPI(void); + bool TINYNVM_ReadMemory(const uint16_t ReadAddress, + uint8_t* ReadBuffer, + uint16_t ReadLength); + bool TINYNVM_WriteMemory(const uint16_t WriteAddress, + uint8_t* WriteBuffer, + uint16_t WriteLength); + bool TINYNVM_EraseMemory(const uint8_t EraseCommand, + const uint16_t Address); + + #if (defined(INCLUDE_FROM_TINYNVM_C) && defined(ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL)) + static void TINYNVM_SendReadNVMRegister(const uint8_t Address); + static void TINYNVM_SendWriteNVMRegister(const uint8_t Address); + static void TINYNVM_SendPointerAddress(const uint16_t AbsoluteAddress); + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/XMEGANVM.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/XMEGANVM.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0208a634b7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/XMEGANVM.c @@ -0,0 +1,468 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Target-related functions for the XMEGA target's NVM module. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_XMEGA_NVM_C +#include "XMEGANVM.h" + +#if defined(ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + +/** Sends the given 32-bit absolute address to the target. + * + * \param[in] AbsoluteAddress Absolute address to send to the target + */ +static void XMEGANVM_SendAddress(const uint32_t AbsoluteAddress) +{ + /* Send the given 32-bit address to the target, LSB first */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(AbsoluteAddress & 0xFF); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(AbsoluteAddress >> 8); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(AbsoluteAddress >> 16); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(AbsoluteAddress >> 24); +} + +/** Sends the given NVM register address to the target. + * + * \param[in] Register NVM register whose absolute address is to be sent + */ +static void XMEGANVM_SendNVMRegAddress(const uint8_t Register) +{ + /* Determine the absolute register address from the NVM base memory address and the NVM register address */ + uint32_t Address = XPROG_Param_NVMBase | Register; + + /* Send the calculated 32-bit address to the target, LSB first */ + XMEGANVM_SendAddress(Address); +} + +/** Busy-waits while the NVM controller is busy performing a NVM operation, such as a FLASH page read or CRC + * calculation. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the NVM controller became ready within the timeout period, \c false otherwise + */ +bool XMEGANVM_WaitWhileNVMBusBusy(void) +{ + /* Poll the STATUS register to check to see if NVM access has been enabled */ + for (;;) + { + /* Send the LDCS command to read the PDI STATUS register to see the NVM bus is active */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_LDCS(PDI_REG_STATUS)); + + uint8_t StatusRegister = XPROGTarget_ReceiveByte(); + + /* We might have timed out waiting for the status register read response, check here */ + if (!(TimeoutTicksRemaining)) + return false; + + /* Check the status register read response to see if the NVM bus is enabled */ + if (StatusRegister & PDI_STATUS_NVM) + return true; + } +} + +/** Waits while the target's NVM controller is busy performing an operation, exiting if the + * timeout period expires. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the NVM controller became ready within the timeout period, \c false otherwise + */ +bool XMEGANVM_WaitWhileNVMControllerBusy(void) +{ + /* Preload the pointer register with the NVM STATUS register address to check the BUSY flag */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_ST(PDI_POINTER_DIRECT, PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES)); + XMEGANVM_SendNVMRegAddress(XMEGA_NVM_REG_STATUS); + + /* Poll the NVM STATUS register while the NVM controller is busy */ + for (;;) + { + /* Fetch the current status value via the pointer register (without auto-increment afterwards) */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_LD(PDI_POINTER_INDIRECT, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + + uint8_t StatusRegister = XPROGTarget_ReceiveByte(); + + /* We might have timed out waiting for the status register read response, check here */ + if (!(TimeoutTicksRemaining)) + return false; + + /* Check to see if the BUSY flag is still set */ + if (!(StatusRegister & (1 << 7))) + return true; + } +} + +/** Enables the physical PDI interface on the target and enables access to the internal NVM controller. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the PDI interface was enabled successfully, \c false otherwise + */ +bool XMEGANVM_EnablePDI(void) +{ + /* Enable PDI programming mode with the attached target */ + XPROGTarget_EnableTargetPDI(); + + /* Store the RESET key into the RESET PDI register to keep the XMEGA in reset */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STCS(PDI_REG_RESET)); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_RESET_KEY); + + /* Lower direction change guard time to 32 USART bits */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STCS(PDI_REG_CTRL)); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(0x02); + + /* Enable access to the XPROG NVM bus by sending the documented NVM access key to the device */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_KEY); + for (uint8_t i = sizeof(PDI_NVMENABLE_KEY); i > 0; i--) + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_NVMENABLE_KEY[i - 1]); + + /* Wait until the NVM bus becomes active */ + return XMEGANVM_WaitWhileNVMBusBusy(); +} + +/** Removes access to the target's NVM controller and physically disables the target's physical PDI interface. */ +void XMEGANVM_DisablePDI(void) +{ + XMEGANVM_WaitWhileNVMBusBusy(); + + /* Clear the RESET key in the RESET PDI register to allow the XMEGA to run - must perform this until the + * change takes effect, as in some cases it takes multiple writes (silicon bug?). + */ + do + { + /* Clear reset register */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STCS(PDI_REG_RESET)); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(0x00); + + /* Read back the reset register, check to see if it took effect */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_LDCS(PDI_REG_RESET)); + } while (XPROGTarget_ReceiveByte() != 0x00); + + XPROGTarget_DisableTargetPDI(); +} + +/** Retrieves the CRC value of the given memory space. + * + * \param[in] CRCCommand NVM CRC command to issue to the target + * \param[out] CRCDest CRC Destination when read from the target + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command sequence complete successfully + */ +bool XMEGANVM_GetMemoryCRC(const uint8_t CRCCommand, + uint32_t* const CRCDest) +{ + *CRCDest = 0; + + /* Wait until the NVM controller is no longer busy */ + if (!(XMEGANVM_WaitWhileNVMControllerBusy())) + return false; + + /* Set the NVM command to the correct CRC read command */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STS(PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XMEGANVM_SendNVMRegAddress(XMEGA_NVM_REG_CMD); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(CRCCommand); + + /* Set CMDEX bit in NVM CTRLA register to start the CRC generation */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STS(PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XMEGANVM_SendNVMRegAddress(XMEGA_NVM_REG_CTRLA); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(XMEGA_NVM_BIT_CTRLA_CMDEX); + + /* Wait until the NVM bus is ready again */ + if (!(XMEGANVM_WaitWhileNVMBusBusy())) + return false; + + /* Wait until the NVM controller is no longer busy */ + if (!(XMEGANVM_WaitWhileNVMControllerBusy())) + return false; + + /* Load the PDI pointer register with the DAT0 register start address */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_ST(PDI_POINTER_DIRECT, PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES)); + XMEGANVM_SendNVMRegAddress(XMEGA_NVM_REG_DAT0); + + /* Send the REPEAT command to grab the CRC bytes */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_REPEAT(PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(XMEGA_CRC_LENGTH_BYTES - 1); + + /* Read in the CRC bytes from the target */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_LD(PDI_POINTER_INDIRECT_PI, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + for (uint8_t i = 0; i < XMEGA_CRC_LENGTH_BYTES; i++) + ((uint8_t*)CRCDest)[i] = XPROGTarget_ReceiveByte(); + + return (TimeoutTicksRemaining > 0); +} + +/** Reads memory from the target's memory spaces. + * + * \param[in] ReadAddress Start address to read from within the target's address space + * \param[out] ReadBuffer Buffer to store read data into + * \param[in] ReadSize Number of bytes to read + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command sequence complete successfully + */ +bool XMEGANVM_ReadMemory(const uint32_t ReadAddress, + uint8_t* ReadBuffer, + uint16_t ReadSize) +{ + /* Wait until the NVM controller is no longer busy */ + if (!(XMEGANVM_WaitWhileNVMControllerBusy())) + return false; + + /* Send the READNVM command to the NVM controller for reading of an arbitrary location */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STS(PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XMEGANVM_SendNVMRegAddress(XMEGA_NVM_REG_CMD); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(XMEGA_NVM_CMD_READNVM); + + if (ReadSize > 1) + { + /* Load the PDI pointer register with the start address we want to read from */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_ST(PDI_POINTER_DIRECT, PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES)); + XMEGANVM_SendAddress(ReadAddress); + + /* Send the REPEAT command with the specified number of bytes to read */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_REPEAT(PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(ReadSize - 1); + + /* Send a LD command with indirect access and post-increment to read out the bytes */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_LD(PDI_POINTER_INDIRECT_PI, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + while (ReadSize-- && TimeoutTicksRemaining) + *(ReadBuffer++) = XPROGTarget_ReceiveByte(); + } + else + { + /* Send a LDS command with the read address to read out the requested byte */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_LDS(PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XMEGANVM_SendAddress(ReadAddress); + *(ReadBuffer++) = XPROGTarget_ReceiveByte(); + } + + return (TimeoutTicksRemaining > 0); +} + +/** Writes byte addressed memory to the target's memory spaces. + * + * \param[in] WriteCommand Command to send to the device to write each memory byte + * \param[in] WriteAddress Address to write to within the target's address space + * \param[in] Byte Byte to write to the target + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command sequence complete successfully + */ +bool XMEGANVM_WriteByteMemory(const uint8_t WriteCommand, + const uint32_t WriteAddress, + const uint8_t Byte) +{ + /* Wait until the NVM controller is no longer busy */ + if (!(XMEGANVM_WaitWhileNVMControllerBusy())) + return false; + + /* Send the memory write command to the target */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STS(PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XMEGANVM_SendNVMRegAddress(XMEGA_NVM_REG_CMD); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(WriteCommand); + + /* Send new memory byte to the memory of the target */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STS(PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XMEGANVM_SendAddress(WriteAddress); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(Byte); + + return true; +} + +/** Writes page addressed memory to the target's memory spaces. + * + * \param[in] WriteBuffCommand Command to send to the device to write a byte to the memory page buffer + * \param[in] EraseBuffCommand Command to send to the device to erase the memory page buffer + * \param[in] WritePageCommand Command to send to the device to write the page buffer to the destination memory + * \param[in] PageMode Bitfield indicating what operations need to be executed on the specified page + * \param[in] WriteAddress Start address to write the page data to within the target's address space + * \param[in] WriteBuffer Buffer to source data from + * \param[in] WriteSize Number of bytes to write + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command sequence complete successfully + */ +bool XMEGANVM_WritePageMemory(const uint8_t WriteBuffCommand, + const uint8_t EraseBuffCommand, + const uint8_t WritePageCommand, + const uint8_t PageMode, + const uint32_t WriteAddress, + const uint8_t* WriteBuffer, + uint16_t WriteSize) +{ + if (PageMode & XPROG_PAGEMODE_ERASE) + { + /* Wait until the NVM controller is no longer busy */ + if (!(XMEGANVM_WaitWhileNVMControllerBusy())) + return false; + + /* Send the memory buffer erase command to the target */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STS(PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XMEGANVM_SendNVMRegAddress(XMEGA_NVM_REG_CMD); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(EraseBuffCommand); + + /* Set CMDEX bit in NVM CTRLA register to start the buffer erase */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STS(PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XMEGANVM_SendNVMRegAddress(XMEGA_NVM_REG_CTRLA); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(XMEGA_NVM_BIT_CTRLA_CMDEX); + } + + if (WriteSize) + { + /* Wait until the NVM controller is no longer busy */ + if (!(XMEGANVM_WaitWhileNVMControllerBusy())) + return false; + + /* Send the memory buffer write command to the target */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STS(PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XMEGANVM_SendNVMRegAddress(XMEGA_NVM_REG_CMD); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(WriteBuffCommand); + + /* Load the PDI pointer register with the start address we want to write to */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_ST(PDI_POINTER_DIRECT, PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES)); + XMEGANVM_SendAddress(WriteAddress); + + /* Send the REPEAT command with the specified number of bytes to write */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_REPEAT(PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(WriteSize - 1); + + /* Send a ST command with indirect access and post-increment to write the bytes */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_ST(PDI_POINTER_INDIRECT_PI, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + while (WriteSize--) + XPROGTarget_SendByte(*(WriteBuffer++)); + } + + if (PageMode & XPROG_PAGEMODE_WRITE) + { + /* Wait until the NVM controller is no longer busy */ + if (!(XMEGANVM_WaitWhileNVMControllerBusy())) + return false; + + /* Send the memory write command to the target */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STS(PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XMEGANVM_SendNVMRegAddress(XMEGA_NVM_REG_CMD); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(WritePageCommand); + + /* Send the address of the first page location to write the memory page */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STS(PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XMEGANVM_SendAddress(WriteAddress); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(0x00); + } + + return true; +} + +/** Erases a specific memory space of the target. + * + * \param[in] EraseCommand NVM erase command to send to the device + * \param[in] Address Address inside the memory space to erase + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command sequence complete successfully + */ +bool XMEGANVM_EraseMemory(const uint8_t EraseCommand, + const uint32_t Address) +{ + /* Wait until the NVM controller is no longer busy */ + if (!(XMEGANVM_WaitWhileNVMControllerBusy())) + return false; + + /* EEPROM and Chip erasures are triggered differently to FLASH section erasures */ + if (EraseCommand == XMEGA_NVM_CMD_CHIPERASE) + { + /* Send the memory erase command to the target */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STS(PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XMEGANVM_SendNVMRegAddress(XMEGA_NVM_REG_CMD); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(EraseCommand); + + /* Set CMDEX bit in NVM CTRLA register to start the erase sequence */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STS(PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XMEGANVM_SendNVMRegAddress(XMEGA_NVM_REG_CTRLA); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(XMEGA_NVM_BIT_CTRLA_CMDEX); + } + else if (EraseCommand == XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEEEPROM) + { + /* Send the EEPROM page buffer erase command to the target */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STS(PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XMEGANVM_SendNVMRegAddress(XMEGA_NVM_REG_CMD); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEEEPROMPAGEBUFF); + + /* Set CMDEX bit in NVM CTRLA register to start the buffer erase */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STS(PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XMEGANVM_SendNVMRegAddress(XMEGA_NVM_REG_CTRLA); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(XMEGA_NVM_BIT_CTRLA_CMDEX); + + /* Wait until the NVM controller is no longer busy */ + if (!(XMEGANVM_WaitWhileNVMControllerBusy())) + return false; + + /* Send the EEPROM memory buffer write command to the target */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STS(PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XMEGANVM_SendNVMRegAddress(XMEGA_NVM_REG_CMD); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(XMEGA_NVM_CMD_LOADEEPROMPAGEBUFF); + + /* Load the PDI pointer register with the EEPROM page start address */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_ST(PDI_POINTER_DIRECT, PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES)); + XMEGANVM_SendAddress(Address); + + /* Send the REPEAT command with the specified number of bytes to write */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_REPEAT(PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(XPROG_Param_EEPageSize - 1); + + /* Send a ST command with indirect access and post-increment to tag each byte in the EEPROM page buffer */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_ST(PDI_POINTER_INDIRECT_PI, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + for (uint8_t PageByte = 0; PageByte < XPROG_Param_EEPageSize; PageByte++) + XPROGTarget_SendByte(0x00); + + /* Send the memory erase command to the target */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STS(PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XMEGANVM_SendNVMRegAddress(XMEGA_NVM_REG_CMD); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(EraseCommand); + + /* Set CMDEX bit in NVM CTRLA register to start the EEPROM erase sequence */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STS(PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XMEGANVM_SendNVMRegAddress(XMEGA_NVM_REG_CTRLA); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(XMEGA_NVM_BIT_CTRLA_CMDEX); + } + else + { + /* Send the memory erase command to the target */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STS(PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XMEGANVM_SendNVMRegAddress(XMEGA_NVM_REG_CMD); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(EraseCommand); + + /* Other erase modes just need us to address a byte within the target memory space */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STS(PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XMEGANVM_SendAddress(Address); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(0x00); + } + + /* Wait until the NVM bus is ready again */ + if (!(XMEGANVM_WaitWhileNVMBusBusy())) + return false; + + return true; +} + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/XMEGANVM.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/XMEGANVM.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8a8c5b048a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/XMEGANVM.h @@ -0,0 +1,140 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for XMEGANVM.c. + */ + +#ifndef _XMEGA_NVM_ +#define _XMEGA_NVM_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdbool.h> + + #include <LUFA/Common/Common.h> + + #include "XPROGProtocol.h" + #include "XPROGTarget.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if ((BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN) || (BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN_REV1)) + #undef ENABLE_ISP_PROTOCOL + + #if !defined(ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL) + #define ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL + #endif + #endif + + /* Defines: */ + #define XMEGA_CRC_LENGTH_BYTES 3 + + #define XMEGA_NVM_REG_ADDR0 0x00 + #define XMEGA_NVM_REG_ADDR1 0x01 + #define XMEGA_NVM_REG_ADDR2 0x02 + #define XMEGA_NVM_REG_DAT0 0x04 + #define XMEGA_NVM_REG_DAT1 0x05 + #define XMEGA_NVM_REG_DAT2 0x06 + #define XMEGA_NVM_REG_CMD 0x0A + #define XMEGA_NVM_REG_CTRLA 0x0B + #define XMEGA_NVM_REG_CTRLB 0x0C + #define XMEGA_NVM_REG_INTCTRL 0x0D + #define XMEGA_NVM_REG_STATUS 0x0F + #define XMEGA_NVM_REG_LOCKBITS 0x10 + + #define XMEGA_NVM_BIT_CTRLA_CMDEX (1 << 0) + + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_NOOP 0x00 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_CHIPERASE 0x40 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_READNVM 0x43 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_LOADFLASHPAGEBUFF 0x23 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEFLASHPAGEBUFF 0x26 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEFLASHPAGE 0x2B + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_WRITEFLASHPAGE 0x2E + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEWRITEFLASH 0x2F + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_FLASHCRC 0x78 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEAPPSEC 0x20 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEAPPSECPAGE 0x22 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_WRITEAPPSECPAGE 0x24 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEWRITEAPPSECPAGE 0x25 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_APPCRC 0x38 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEBOOTSEC 0x68 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEBOOTSECPAGE 0x2A + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_WRITEBOOTSECPAGE 0x2C + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEWRITEBOOTSECPAGE 0x2D + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_BOOTCRC 0x39 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_READUSERSIG 0x03 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEUSERSIG 0x18 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_WRITEUSERSIG 0x1A + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_READCALIBRATION 0x02 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_READFUSE 0x07 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_WRITEFUSE 0x4C + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_WRITELOCK 0x08 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_LOADEEPROMPAGEBUFF 0x33 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEEEPROMPAGEBUFF 0x36 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEEEPROM 0x30 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEEEPROMPAGE 0x32 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_WRITEEEPROMPAGE 0x34 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEWRITEEEPROMPAGE 0x35 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_READEEPROM 0x06 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + bool XMEGANVM_WaitWhileNVMBusBusy(void); + bool XMEGANVM_WaitWhileNVMControllerBusy(void); + bool XMEGANVM_EnablePDI(void); + void XMEGANVM_DisablePDI(void); + bool XMEGANVM_GetMemoryCRC(const uint8_t CRCCommand, + uint32_t* const CRCDest); + bool XMEGANVM_ReadMemory(const uint32_t ReadAddress, + uint8_t* ReadBuffer, + uint16_t ReadSize); + bool XMEGANVM_WriteByteMemory(const uint8_t WriteCommand, + const uint32_t WriteAddress, + const uint8_t Byte); + bool XMEGANVM_WritePageMemory(const uint8_t WriteBuffCommand, + const uint8_t EraseBuffCommand, + const uint8_t WritePageCommand, + const uint8_t PageMode, + const uint32_t WriteAddress, + const uint8_t* WriteBuffer, + uint16_t WriteSize); + bool XMEGANVM_EraseMemory(const uint8_t EraseCommand, + const uint32_t Address); + + #if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_XMEGANVM_C) + static void XMEGANVM_SendNVMRegAddress(const uint8_t Register); + static void XMEGANVM_SendAddress(const uint32_t AbsoluteAddress); + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/XPROGProtocol.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/XPROGProtocol.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..aa5503f3ff --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/XPROGProtocol.c @@ -0,0 +1,480 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * XPROG Protocol handler, to process V2 Protocol wrapped XPROG commands used in Atmel programmer devices. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_XPROGPROTOCOL_C +#include "XPROGProtocol.h" + +#if defined(ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) +/** Base absolute address for the target's NVM controller for PDI programming */ +uint32_t XPROG_Param_NVMBase = 0x010001C0; + +/** Size in bytes of the target's EEPROM page */ +uint16_t XPROG_Param_EEPageSize = 32; + +/** Address of the TPI device's NVMCMD register for TPI programming */ +uint8_t XPROG_Param_NVMCMDRegAddr = 0x33; + +/** Address of the TPI device's NVMCSR register for TPI programming */ +uint8_t XPROG_Param_NVMCSRRegAddr = 0x32; + +/** Currently selected XPROG programming protocol */ +uint8_t XPROG_SelectedProtocol = XPROG_PROTOCOL_PDI; + +/** Handler for the CMD_XPROG_SETMODE command, which sets the programmer-to-target protocol used for PDI/TPI + * programming. + */ +void XPROGProtocol_SetMode(void) +{ + struct + { + uint8_t Protocol; + } SetMode_XPROG_Params; + + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&SetMode_XPROG_Params, sizeof(SetMode_XPROG_Params), NULL); + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + XPROG_SelectedProtocol = SetMode_XPROG_Params.Protocol; + + Endpoint_Write_8(CMD_XPROG_SETMODE); + Endpoint_Write_8((SetMode_XPROG_Params.Protocol != XPROG_PROTOCOL_JTAG) ? STATUS_CMD_OK : STATUS_CMD_FAILED); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + +/** Handler for the CMD_XPROG command, which wraps up XPROG commands in a V2 wrapper which need to be + * removed and processed so that the underlying XPROG command can be handled. + */ +void XPROGProtocol_Command(void) +{ + uint8_t XPROGCommand = Endpoint_Read_8(); + + switch (XPROGCommand) + { + case XPROG_CMD_ENTER_PROGMODE: + XPROGProtocol_EnterXPROGMode(); + break; + case XPROG_CMD_LEAVE_PROGMODE: + XPROGProtocol_LeaveXPROGMode(); + break; + case XPROG_CMD_ERASE: + XPROGProtocol_Erase(); + break; + case XPROG_CMD_WRITE_MEM: + XPROGProtocol_WriteMemory(); + break; + case XPROG_CMD_READ_MEM: + XPROGProtocol_ReadMemory(); + break; + case XPROG_CMD_CRC: + XPROGProtocol_ReadCRC(); + break; + case XPROG_CMD_SET_PARAM: + XPROGProtocol_SetParam(); + break; + } +} + +/** Handler for the XPROG ENTER_PROGMODE command to establish a connection with the attached device. */ +static void XPROGProtocol_EnterXPROGMode(void) +{ + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + bool NVMBusEnabled = false; + + if (XPROG_SelectedProtocol == XPROG_PROTOCOL_PDI) + NVMBusEnabled = XMEGANVM_EnablePDI(); + else if (XPROG_SelectedProtocol == XPROG_PROTOCOL_TPI) + NVMBusEnabled = TINYNVM_EnableTPI(); + + Endpoint_Write_8(CMD_XPROG); + Endpoint_Write_8(XPROG_CMD_ENTER_PROGMODE); + Endpoint_Write_8(NVMBusEnabled ? XPROG_ERR_OK : XPROG_ERR_FAILED); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + +/** Handler for the XPROG LEAVE_PROGMODE command to terminate the PDI programming connection with + * the attached device. + */ +static void XPROGProtocol_LeaveXPROGMode(void) +{ + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + if (XPROG_SelectedProtocol == XPROG_PROTOCOL_PDI) + XMEGANVM_DisablePDI(); + else + TINYNVM_DisableTPI(); + + #if defined(XCK_RESCUE_CLOCK_ENABLE) && defined(ENABLE_ISP_PROTOCOL) + /* If the XCK rescue clock option is enabled, we need to restart it once the + * XPROG mode has been exited, since the XPROG protocol stops it after use. */ + ISPTarget_ConfigureRescueClock(); + #endif + + Endpoint_Write_8(CMD_XPROG); + Endpoint_Write_8(XPROG_CMD_LEAVE_PROGMODE); + Endpoint_Write_8(XPROG_ERR_OK); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + +/** Handler for the XPRG ERASE command to erase a specific memory address space in the attached device. */ +static void XPROGProtocol_Erase(void) +{ + uint8_t ReturnStatus = XPROG_ERR_OK; + + struct + { + uint8_t MemoryType; + uint32_t Address; + } Erase_XPROG_Params; + + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&Erase_XPROG_Params, sizeof(Erase_XPROG_Params), NULL); + Erase_XPROG_Params.Address = SwapEndian_32(Erase_XPROG_Params.Address); + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + uint8_t EraseCommand; + + if (XPROG_SelectedProtocol == XPROG_PROTOCOL_PDI) + { + /* Determine which NVM command to send to the device depending on the memory to erase */ + switch (Erase_XPROG_Params.MemoryType) + { + case XPROG_ERASE_CHIP: + EraseCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_CHIPERASE; + break; + case XPROG_ERASE_APP: + EraseCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEAPPSEC; + break; + case XPROG_ERASE_BOOT: + EraseCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEBOOTSEC; + break; + case XPROG_ERASE_EEPROM: + EraseCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEEEPROM; + break; + case XPROG_ERASE_APP_PAGE: + EraseCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEAPPSECPAGE; + break; + case XPROG_ERASE_BOOT_PAGE: + EraseCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEBOOTSECPAGE; + break; + case XPROG_ERASE_EEPROM_PAGE: + EraseCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEEEPROMPAGE; + break; + case XPROG_ERASE_USERSIG: + EraseCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEUSERSIG; + break; + default: + EraseCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_NOOP; + break; + } + + /* Erase the target memory, indicate timeout if occurred */ + if (!(XMEGANVM_EraseMemory(EraseCommand, Erase_XPROG_Params.Address))) + ReturnStatus = XPROG_ERR_TIMEOUT; + } + else + { + if (Erase_XPROG_Params.MemoryType == XPROG_ERASE_CHIP) + EraseCommand = TINY_NVM_CMD_CHIPERASE; + else + EraseCommand = TINY_NVM_CMD_SECTIONERASE; + + /* Erase the target memory, indicate timeout if occurred */ + if (!(TINYNVM_EraseMemory(EraseCommand, Erase_XPROG_Params.Address))) + ReturnStatus = XPROG_ERR_TIMEOUT; + } + + Endpoint_Write_8(CMD_XPROG); + Endpoint_Write_8(XPROG_CMD_ERASE); + Endpoint_Write_8(ReturnStatus); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + +/** Handler for the XPROG WRITE_MEMORY command to write to a specific memory space within the attached device. */ +static void XPROGProtocol_WriteMemory(void) +{ + uint8_t ReturnStatus = XPROG_ERR_OK; + + struct + { + uint8_t MemoryType; + uint8_t PageMode; + uint32_t Address; + uint16_t Length; + uint8_t ProgData[256]; + } WriteMemory_XPROG_Params; + + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&WriteMemory_XPROG_Params, (sizeof(WriteMemory_XPROG_Params) - + sizeof(WriteMemory_XPROG_Params).ProgData), NULL); + WriteMemory_XPROG_Params.Address = SwapEndian_32(WriteMemory_XPROG_Params.Address); + WriteMemory_XPROG_Params.Length = SwapEndian_16(WriteMemory_XPROG_Params.Length); + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&WriteMemory_XPROG_Params.ProgData, WriteMemory_XPROG_Params.Length, NULL); + + // The driver will terminate transfers that are a round multiple of the endpoint bank in size with a ZLP, need + // to catch this and discard it before continuing on with packet processing to prevent communication issues + if (((sizeof(uint8_t) + sizeof(WriteMemory_XPROG_Params) - sizeof(WriteMemory_XPROG_Params.ProgData)) + + WriteMemory_XPROG_Params.Length) % AVRISP_DATA_EPSIZE == 0) + { + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_WaitUntilReady(); + } + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + if (XPROG_SelectedProtocol == XPROG_PROTOCOL_PDI) + { + /* Assume FLASH page programming by default, as it is the common case */ + uint8_t WriteCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_WRITEFLASHPAGE; + uint8_t WriteBuffCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_LOADFLASHPAGEBUFF; + uint8_t EraseBuffCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEFLASHPAGEBUFF; + bool PagedMemory = true; + + switch (WriteMemory_XPROG_Params.MemoryType) + { + case XPROG_MEM_TYPE_APPL: + WriteCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_WRITEAPPSECPAGE; + break; + case XPROG_MEM_TYPE_BOOT: + WriteCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_WRITEBOOTSECPAGE; + break; + case XPROG_MEM_TYPE_EEPROM: + WriteCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEWRITEEEPROMPAGE; + WriteBuffCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_LOADEEPROMPAGEBUFF; + EraseBuffCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEEEPROMPAGEBUFF; + break; + case XPROG_MEM_TYPE_USERSIG: + WriteCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_WRITEUSERSIG; + break; + case XPROG_MEM_TYPE_FUSE: + WriteCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_WRITEFUSE; + PagedMemory = false; + break; + case XPROG_MEM_TYPE_LOCKBITS: + WriteCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_WRITELOCK; + PagedMemory = false; + break; + } + + /* Send the appropriate memory write commands to the device, indicate timeout if occurred */ + if ((PagedMemory && !(XMEGANVM_WritePageMemory(WriteBuffCommand, EraseBuffCommand, WriteCommand, + WriteMemory_XPROG_Params.PageMode, WriteMemory_XPROG_Params.Address, + WriteMemory_XPROG_Params.ProgData, WriteMemory_XPROG_Params.Length))) || + (!PagedMemory && !(XMEGANVM_WriteByteMemory(WriteCommand, WriteMemory_XPROG_Params.Address, + WriteMemory_XPROG_Params.ProgData[0])))) + { + ReturnStatus = XPROG_ERR_TIMEOUT; + } + } + else + { + /* Send write command to the TPI device, indicate timeout if occurred */ + if (!(TINYNVM_WriteMemory(WriteMemory_XPROG_Params.Address, WriteMemory_XPROG_Params.ProgData, + WriteMemory_XPROG_Params.Length))) + { + ReturnStatus = XPROG_ERR_TIMEOUT; + } + } + + Endpoint_Write_8(CMD_XPROG); + Endpoint_Write_8(XPROG_CMD_WRITE_MEM); + Endpoint_Write_8(ReturnStatus); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + +/** Handler for the XPROG READ_MEMORY command to read data from a specific address space within the + * attached device. + */ +static void XPROGProtocol_ReadMemory(void) +{ + uint8_t ReturnStatus = XPROG_ERR_OK; + + struct + { + uint8_t MemoryType; + uint32_t Address; + uint16_t Length; + } ReadMemory_XPROG_Params; + + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&ReadMemory_XPROG_Params, sizeof(ReadMemory_XPROG_Params), NULL); + ReadMemory_XPROG_Params.Address = SwapEndian_32(ReadMemory_XPROG_Params.Address); + ReadMemory_XPROG_Params.Length = SwapEndian_16(ReadMemory_XPROG_Params.Length); + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + uint8_t ReadBuffer[256]; + + if (XPROG_SelectedProtocol == XPROG_PROTOCOL_PDI) + { + /* Read the PDI target's memory, indicate timeout if occurred */ + if (!(XMEGANVM_ReadMemory(ReadMemory_XPROG_Params.Address, ReadBuffer, ReadMemory_XPROG_Params.Length))) + ReturnStatus = XPROG_ERR_TIMEOUT; + } + else + { + /* Read the TPI target's memory, indicate timeout if occurred */ + if (!(TINYNVM_ReadMemory(ReadMemory_XPROG_Params.Address, ReadBuffer, ReadMemory_XPROG_Params.Length))) + ReturnStatus = XPROG_ERR_TIMEOUT; + } + + Endpoint_Write_8(CMD_XPROG); + Endpoint_Write_8(XPROG_CMD_READ_MEM); + Endpoint_Write_8(ReturnStatus); + + if (ReturnStatus == XPROG_ERR_OK) + Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(ReadBuffer, ReadMemory_XPROG_Params.Length, NULL); + + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + +/** Handler for the XPROG CRC command to read a specific memory space's CRC value for comparison between the + * attached device's memory and a data set on the host. + */ +static void XPROGProtocol_ReadCRC(void) +{ + uint8_t ReturnStatus = XPROG_ERR_OK; + + struct + { + uint8_t CRCType; + } ReadCRC_XPROG_Params; + + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&ReadCRC_XPROG_Params, sizeof(ReadCRC_XPROG_Params), NULL); + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + uint32_t MemoryCRC; + + if (XPROG_SelectedProtocol == XPROG_PROTOCOL_PDI) + { + uint8_t CRCCommand; + + /* Determine which NVM command to send to the device depending on the memory to CRC */ + switch (ReadCRC_XPROG_Params.CRCType) + { + case XPROG_CRC_APP: + CRCCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_APPCRC; + break; + case XPROG_CRC_BOOT: + CRCCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_BOOTCRC; + break; + default: + CRCCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_FLASHCRC; + break; + } + + /* Perform and retrieve the memory CRC, indicate timeout if occurred */ + if (!(XMEGANVM_GetMemoryCRC(CRCCommand, &MemoryCRC))) + ReturnStatus = XPROG_ERR_TIMEOUT; + } + else + { + /* TPI does not support memory CRC */ + ReturnStatus = XPROG_ERR_FAILED; + } + + Endpoint_Write_8(CMD_XPROG); + Endpoint_Write_8(XPROG_CMD_CRC); + Endpoint_Write_8(ReturnStatus); + + if (ReturnStatus == XPROG_ERR_OK) + { + Endpoint_Write_8(MemoryCRC >> 16); + Endpoint_Write_16_LE(MemoryCRC & 0xFFFF); + } + + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + +/** Handler for the XPROG SET_PARAM command to set a XPROG parameter for use when communicating with the + * attached device. + */ +static void XPROGProtocol_SetParam(void) +{ + uint8_t ReturnStatus = XPROG_ERR_OK; + + uint8_t XPROGParam = Endpoint_Read_8(); + + /* Determine which parameter is being set, store the new parameter value */ + switch (XPROGParam) + { + case XPROG_PARAM_NVMBASE: + XPROG_Param_NVMBase = Endpoint_Read_32_BE(); + break; + case XPROG_PARAM_EEPPAGESIZE: + XPROG_Param_EEPageSize = Endpoint_Read_16_BE(); + break; + case XPROG_PARAM_NVMCMD_REG: + XPROG_Param_NVMCMDRegAddr = Endpoint_Read_8(); + break; + case XPROG_PARAM_NVMCSR_REG: + XPROG_Param_NVMCSRRegAddr = Endpoint_Read_8(); + break; + case XPROG_PARAM_UNKNOWN_1: + /* TODO: Undocumented parameter added in AVRStudio 5.1, purpose unknown. Must ACK and discard or + the communication with AVRStudio 5.1 will fail. + */ + Endpoint_Discard_16(); + break; + default: + ReturnStatus = XPROG_ERR_FAILED; + break; + } + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + Endpoint_Write_8(CMD_XPROG); + Endpoint_Write_8(XPROG_CMD_SET_PARAM); + Endpoint_Write_8(ReturnStatus); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/XPROGProtocol.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/XPROGProtocol.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e35a1e4a19 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/XPROGProtocol.h @@ -0,0 +1,136 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for XPROGProtocol.c. + */ + +#ifndef _XPROG_PROTOCOL_ +#define _XPROG_PROTOCOL_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <util/delay.h> + #include <stdio.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "../V2Protocol.h" + #include "XMEGANVM.h" + #include "TINYNVM.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if ((BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN) || (BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN_REV1)) + /* On the XPLAIN board, we only need PDI programming + for the ATXMEGA128A1 - disable ISP to prevent hardware + damage and force-enable XPROG. + */ + #undef ENABLE_ISP_PROTOCOL + + #if !defined(ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL) + #define ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL + #endif + #endif + + /* Macros: */ + #define XPROG_CMD_ENTER_PROGMODE 0x01 + #define XPROG_CMD_LEAVE_PROGMODE 0x02 + #define XPROG_CMD_ERASE 0x03 + #define XPROG_CMD_WRITE_MEM 0x04 + #define XPROG_CMD_READ_MEM 0x05 + #define XPROG_CMD_CRC 0x06 + #define XPROG_CMD_SET_PARAM 0x07 + + #define XPROG_MEM_TYPE_APPL 1 + #define XPROG_MEM_TYPE_BOOT 2 + #define XPROG_MEM_TYPE_EEPROM 3 + #define XPROG_MEM_TYPE_FUSE 4 + #define XPROG_MEM_TYPE_LOCKBITS 5 + #define XPROG_MEM_TYPE_USERSIG 6 + #define XPROG_MEM_TYPE_FACTORY_CALIBRATION 7 + + #define XPROG_ERASE_CHIP 1 + #define XPROG_ERASE_APP 2 + #define XPROG_ERASE_BOOT 3 + #define XPROG_ERASE_EEPROM 4 + #define XPROG_ERASE_APP_PAGE 5 + #define XPROG_ERASE_BOOT_PAGE 6 + #define XPROG_ERASE_EEPROM_PAGE 7 + #define XPROG_ERASE_USERSIG 8 + + #define XPROG_MEM_WRITE_ERASE 0 + #define XPROG_MEM_WRITE_WRITE 1 + + #define XPROG_CRC_APP 1 + #define XPROG_CRC_BOOT 2 + #define XPROG_CRC_FLASH 3 + + #define XPROG_ERR_OK 0 + #define XPROG_ERR_FAILED 1 + #define XPROG_ERR_COLLISION 2 + #define XPROG_ERR_TIMEOUT 3 + + #define XPROG_PARAM_NVMBASE 0x01 + #define XPROG_PARAM_EEPPAGESIZE 0x02 + #define XPROG_PARAM_NVMCMD_REG 0x03 + #define XPROG_PARAM_NVMCSR_REG 0x04 + #define XPROG_PARAM_UNKNOWN_1 0x05 + + #define XPROG_PROTOCOL_PDI 0x00 + #define XPROG_PROTOCOL_JTAG 0x01 + #define XPROG_PROTOCOL_TPI 0x02 + + #define XPROG_PAGEMODE_WRITE (1 << 1) + #define XPROG_PAGEMODE_ERASE (1 << 0) + + /* External Variables: */ + extern uint32_t XPROG_Param_NVMBase; + extern uint16_t XPROG_Param_EEPageSize; + extern uint8_t XPROG_Param_NVMCSRRegAddr; + extern uint8_t XPROG_Param_NVMCMDRegAddr; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void XPROGProtocol_SetMode(void); + void XPROGProtocol_Command(void); + + #if (defined(INCLUDE_FROM_XPROGPROTOCOL_C) && defined(ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL)) + static void XPROGProtocol_EnterXPROGMode(void); + static void XPROGProtocol_LeaveXPROGMode(void); + static void XPROGProtocol_SetParam(void); + static void XPROGProtocol_Erase(void); + static void XPROGProtocol_WriteMemory(void); + static void XPROGProtocol_ReadMemory(void); + static void XPROGProtocol_ReadCRC(void); + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/XPROGTarget.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/XPROGTarget.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0455329c3d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/XPROGTarget.c @@ -0,0 +1,209 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Target-related functions for the PDI Protocol decoder. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_XPROGTARGET_C +#include "XPROGTarget.h" + +#if defined(ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + +/** Flag to indicate if the USART is currently in Tx or Rx mode. */ +bool IsSending; + +/** Enables the target's PDI interface, holding the target in reset until PDI mode is exited. */ +void XPROGTarget_EnableTargetPDI(void) +{ + IsSending = false; + + /* Set Tx and XCK as outputs, Rx as input */ + DDRD |= (1 << 5) | (1 << 3); + DDRD &= ~(1 << 2); + + /* Set DATA line high for at least 90ns to disable /RESET functionality */ + PORTD |= (1 << 3); + _delay_us(100); + + /* Set up the synchronous USART for XMEGA communications - 8 data bits, even parity, 2 stop bits */ + UBRR1 = ((F_CPU / 2 / XPROG_HARDWARE_SPEED) - 1); + UCSR1B = (1 << TXEN1); + UCSR1C = (1 << UMSEL10) | (1 << UPM11) | (1 << USBS1) | (1 << UCSZ11) | (1 << UCSZ10) | (1 << UCPOL1); + + /* Send two IDLEs of 12 bits each to enable PDI interface (need at least 16 idle bits) */ + XPROGTarget_SendIdle(); + XPROGTarget_SendIdle(); +} + +/** Enables the target's TPI interface, holding the target in reset until TPI mode is exited. */ +void XPROGTarget_EnableTargetTPI(void) +{ + IsSending = false; + + /* Set /RESET line low for at least 400ns to enable TPI functionality */ + AUX_LINE_DDR |= AUX_LINE_MASK; + AUX_LINE_PORT &= ~AUX_LINE_MASK; + _delay_us(100); + + /* Set Tx and XCK as outputs, Rx as input */ + DDRD |= (1 << 5) | (1 << 3); + DDRD &= ~(1 << 2); + + /* Set up the synchronous USART for TPI communications - 8 data bits, even parity, 2 stop bits */ + UBRR1 = ((F_CPU / 2 / XPROG_HARDWARE_SPEED) - 1); + UCSR1B = (1 << TXEN1); + UCSR1C = (1 << UMSEL10) | (1 << UPM11) | (1 << USBS1) | (1 << UCSZ11) | (1 << UCSZ10) | (1 << UCPOL1); + + /* Send two IDLEs of 12 bits each to enable TPI interface (need at least 16 idle bits) */ + XPROGTarget_SendIdle(); + XPROGTarget_SendIdle(); +} + +/** Disables the target's PDI interface, exits programming mode and starts the target's application. */ +void XPROGTarget_DisableTargetPDI(void) +{ + /* Switch to Rx mode to ensure that all pending transmissions are complete */ + if (IsSending) + XPROGTarget_SetRxMode(); + + /* Turn off receiver and transmitter of the USART, clear settings */ + UCSR1A = ((1 << TXC1) | (1 << RXC1)); + UCSR1B = 0; + UCSR1C = 0; + + /* Tristate all pins */ + DDRD &= ~((1 << 5) | (1 << 3)); + PORTD &= ~((1 << 5) | (1 << 3) | (1 << 2)); +} + +/** Disables the target's TPI interface, exits programming mode and starts the target's application. */ +void XPROGTarget_DisableTargetTPI(void) +{ + /* Switch to Rx mode to ensure that all pending transmissions are complete */ + if (IsSending) + XPROGTarget_SetRxMode(); + + /* Turn off receiver and transmitter of the USART, clear settings */ + UCSR1A |= (1 << TXC1) | (1 << RXC1); + UCSR1B = 0; + UCSR1C = 0; + + /* Set all USART lines as inputs, tristate */ + DDRD &= ~((1 << 5) | (1 << 3)); + PORTD &= ~((1 << 5) | (1 << 3) | (1 << 2)); + + /* Tristate target /RESET line */ + AUX_LINE_DDR &= ~AUX_LINE_MASK; + AUX_LINE_PORT &= ~AUX_LINE_MASK; +} + +/** Sends a byte via the USART. + * + * \param[in] Byte Byte to send through the USART + */ +void XPROGTarget_SendByte(const uint8_t Byte) +{ + /* Switch to Tx mode if currently in Rx mode */ + if (!(IsSending)) + XPROGTarget_SetTxMode(); + + /* Wait until there is space in the hardware Tx buffer before writing */ + while (!(UCSR1A & (1 << UDRE1))); + UCSR1A |= (1 << TXC1); + UDR1 = Byte; +} + +/** Receives a byte via the hardware USART, blocking until data is received or timeout expired. + * + * \return Received byte from the USART + */ +uint8_t XPROGTarget_ReceiveByte(void) +{ + /* Switch to Rx mode if currently in Tx mode */ + if (IsSending) + XPROGTarget_SetRxMode(); + + /* Wait until a byte has been received before reading */ + while (!(UCSR1A & (1 << RXC1)) && TimeoutTicksRemaining); + + return UDR1; +} + +/** Sends an IDLE via the USART to the attached target, consisting of a full frame of idle bits. */ +void XPROGTarget_SendIdle(void) +{ + /* Switch to Tx mode if currently in Rx mode */ + if (!(IsSending)) + XPROGTarget_SetTxMode(); + + /* Need to do nothing for a full frame to send an IDLE */ + for (uint8_t i = 0; i < BITS_IN_USART_FRAME; i++) + { + /* Wait for a full cycle of the clock */ + while (PIND & (1 << 5)); + while (!(PIND & (1 << 5))); + while (PIND & (1 << 5)); + } +} + +static void XPROGTarget_SetTxMode(void) +{ + /* Wait for a full cycle of the clock */ + while (PIND & (1 << 5)); + while (!(PIND & (1 << 5))); + while (PIND & (1 << 5)); + + PORTD |= (1 << 3); + DDRD |= (1 << 3); + + UCSR1B &= ~(1 << RXEN1); + UCSR1B |= (1 << TXEN1); + + IsSending = true; +} + +static void XPROGTarget_SetRxMode(void) +{ + while (!(UCSR1A & (1 << TXC1))); + UCSR1A |= (1 << TXC1); + + UCSR1B &= ~(1 << TXEN1); + UCSR1B |= (1 << RXEN1); + + DDRD &= ~(1 << 3); + PORTD &= ~(1 << 3); + + IsSending = false; +} + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/XPROGTarget.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/XPROGTarget.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1341384f2f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/XPROGTarget.h @@ -0,0 +1,136 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for XPROGTarget.c. + */ + +#ifndef _XPROG_TARGET_ +#define _XPROG_TARGET_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdbool.h> + + #include <LUFA/Common/Common.h> + + #include "../V2Protocol.h" + #include "XPROGProtocol.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if ((BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN) || (BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN_REV1)) + #undef ENABLE_ISP_PROTOCOL + + #if !defined(ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL) + #define ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL + #endif + #endif + + /** Serial carrier TPI/PDI speed in Hz, when hardware TPI/PDI mode is used. */ + #define XPROG_HARDWARE_SPEED 2000000 + + /** Total number of bits in a single USART frame. */ + #define BITS_IN_USART_FRAME 12 + + /** \name PDI Related Constants + * @{ + */ + #define PDI_CMD_LDS(AddressSize, DataSize) (0x00 | ( AddressSize << 2) | DataSize) + #define PDI_CMD_LD(PointerAccess, DataSize) (0x20 | (PointerAccess << 2) | DataSize) + #define PDI_CMD_STS(AddressSize, DataSize) (0x40 | ( AddressSize << 2) | DataSize) + #define PDI_CMD_ST(PointerAccess, DataSize) (0x60 | (PointerAccess << 2) | DataSize) + #define PDI_CMD_LDCS(PDIReg) (0x80 | PDIReg) + #define PDI_CMD_REPEAT(DataSize) (0xA0 | DataSize) + #define PDI_CMD_STCS(PDIReg) (0xC0 | PDIReg) + #define PDI_CMD_KEY 0xE0 + + #define PDI_REG_STATUS 0 + #define PDI_REG_RESET 1 + #define PDI_REG_CTRL 2 + + #define PDI_STATUS_NVM (1 << 1) + + #define PDI_RESET_KEY 0x59 + #define PDI_NVMENABLE_KEY (uint8_t[]){0x12, 0x89, 0xAB, 0x45, 0xCD, 0xD8, 0x88, 0xFF} + + #define PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE 0 + #define PDI_DATASIZE_2BYTES 1 + #define PDI_DATASIZE_3BYTES 2 + #define PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES 3 + + #define PDI_POINTER_INDIRECT 0 + #define PDI_POINTER_INDIRECT_PI 1 + #define PDI_POINTER_DIRECT 2 + /** @} */ + + /** \name TPI Related Constants + * @{ + */ + #define TPI_CMD_SLD(PointerAccess) (0x20 | PointerAccess) + #define TPI_CMD_SST(PointerAccess) (0x60 | PointerAccess) + #define TPI_CMD_SSTPR 0x68 + #define TPI_CMD_SIN(Address) (0x10 | ((Address & 0x30) << 1) | (Address & 0x0F)) + #define TPI_CMD_SOUT(Address) (0x90 | ((Address & 0x30) << 1) | (Address & 0x0F)) + #define TPI_CMD_SLDCS(TPIReg) (0x80 | TPIReg) + #define TPI_CMD_SSTCS(TPIReg) (0xC0 | TPIReg) + #define TPI_CMD_SKEY 0xE0 + + #define TPI_REG_STATUS 0x00 + #define TPI_REG_CTRL 0x02 + #define TPI_REG_ID 0x0F + + #define TPI_STATUS_NVM (1 << 1) + + #define TPI_NVMENABLE_KEY (uint8_t[]){0x12, 0x89, 0xAB, 0x45, 0xCD, 0xD8, 0x88, 0xFF} + + #define TPI_POINTER_INDIRECT 0 + #define TPI_POINTER_INDIRECT_PI 4 + /** @} */ + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void XPROGTarget_EnableTargetPDI(void); + void XPROGTarget_EnableTargetTPI(void); + void XPROGTarget_DisableTargetPDI(void); + void XPROGTarget_DisableTargetTPI(void); + void XPROGTarget_SendByte(const uint8_t Byte); + uint8_t XPROGTarget_ReceiveByte(void); + void XPROGTarget_SendIdle(void); + bool XPROGTarget_WaitWhileNVMBusBusy(void); + + #if (defined(INCLUDE_FROM_XPROGTARGET_C) && defined(ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL)) + static void XPROGTarget_SetTxMode(void); + static void XPROGTarget_SetRxMode(void); + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/AVRISP_mkII.inf b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/AVRISP_mkII.inf Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000000..81ea412280 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/AVRISP_mkII.inf diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/amd64/libusb0.dll b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/amd64/libusb0.dll Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f916b08986 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/amd64/libusb0.dll diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/amd64/libusb0.sys b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/amd64/libusb0.sys Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0718dfb7c0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/amd64/libusb0.sys diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/avrisp_mkii.cat b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/avrisp_mkii.cat Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9f004a584c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/avrisp_mkii.cat diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/ia64/libusb0.dll b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/ia64/libusb0.dll Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000000..292df27857 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/ia64/libusb0.dll diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/ia64/libusb0.sys b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/ia64/libusb0.sys Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f17914b8c4 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/ia64/libusb0.sys diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/installer_x64.exe b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/installer_x64.exe Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c38919ee50 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/installer_x64.exe diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/installer_x86.exe b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/installer_x86.exe Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000000..030ec300c2 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/installer_x86.exe diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/license/libusb0/installer_license.txt b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/license/libusb0/installer_license.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..56bb2cda25 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/license/libusb0/installer_license.txt @@ -0,0 +1,851 @@ +Copyright (c) 2002-2004 Stephan Meyer, <ste_meyer@web.de> +Copyright (c) 2000-2004 Johannes Erdfelt, <johannes@erdfelt.com> +Copyright (c) 2000-2004 Thomas Sailer, <sailer@ife.ee.ethz.ch> +Copyright (c) 2010 Travis Robinson, <libusbdotnet@gmail.com> + +This software is distributed under the following licenses: +Driver: GNU General Public License (GPL) +Library, Test Files, Installer: GNU Lesser General Public License (LGPL) + +*********************************************************************** + GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE + Version 3, 29 June 2007 + + Copyright (C) 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc. <http://fsf.org/> + Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies + of this license document, but changing it is not allowed. + + Preamble + + The GNU General Public License is a free, copyleft license for +software and other kinds of works. + + The licenses for most software and other practical works are designed +to take away your freedom to share and change the works. By contrast, +the GNU General Public License is intended to guarantee your freedom to +share and change all versions of a program--to make sure it remains free +software for all its users. We, the Free Software Foundation, use the +GNU General Public License for most of our software; it applies also to +any other work released this way by its authors. You can apply it to +your programs, too. + + When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom, not +price. Our General Public Licenses are designed to make sure that you +have the freedom to distribute copies of free software (and charge for +them if you wish), that you receive source code or can get it if you +want it, that you can change the software or use pieces of it in new +free programs, and that you know you can do these things. + + To protect your rights, we need to prevent others from denying you +these rights or asking you to surrender the rights. Therefore, you have +certain responsibilities if you distribute copies of the software, or if +you modify it: responsibilities to respect the freedom of others. + + For example, if you distribute copies of such a program, whether +gratis or for a fee, you must pass on to the recipients the same +freedoms that you received. You must make sure that they, too, receive +or can get the source code. And you must show them these terms so they +know their rights. + + Developers that use the GNU GPL protect your rights with two steps: +(1) assert copyright on the software, and (2) offer you this License +giving you legal permission to copy, distribute and/or modify it. + + For the developers' and authors' protection, the GPL clearly explains +that there is no warranty for this free software. For both users' and +authors' sake, the GPL requires that modified versions be marked as +changed, so that their problems will not be attributed erroneously to +authors of previous versions. + + Some devices are designed to deny users access to install or run +modified versions of the software inside them, although the manufacturer +can do so. This is fundamentally incompatible with the aim of +protecting users' freedom to change the software. The systematic +pattern of such abuse occurs in the area of products for individuals to +use, which is precisely where it is most unacceptable. Therefore, we +have designed this version of the GPL to prohibit the practice for those +products. If such problems arise substantially in other domains, we +stand ready to extend this provision to those domains in future versions +of the GPL, as needed to protect the freedom of users. + + Finally, every program is threatened constantly by software patents. +States should not allow patents to restrict development and use of +software on general-purpose computers, but in those that do, we wish to +avoid the special danger that patents applied to a free program could +make it effectively proprietary. To prevent this, the GPL assures that +patents cannot be used to render the program non-free. + + The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and +modification follow. + + TERMS AND CONDITIONS + + 0. Definitions. + + "This License" refers to version 3 of the GNU General Public License. + + "Copyright" also means copyright-like laws that apply to other kinds of +works, such as semiconductor masks. + + "The Program" refers to any copyrightable work licensed under this +License. Each licensee is addressed as "you". "Licensees" and +"recipients" may be individuals or organizations. + + To "modify" a work means to copy from or adapt all or part of the work +in a fashion requiring copyright permission, other than the making of an +exact copy. The resulting work is called a "modified version" of the +earlier work or a work "based on" the earlier work. + + A "covered work" means either the unmodified Program or a work based +on the Program. + + To "propagate" a work means to do anything with it that, without +permission, would make you directly or secondarily liable for +infringement under applicable copyright law, except executing it on a +computer or modifying a private copy. Propagation includes copying, +distribution (with or without modification), making available to the +public, and in some countries other activities as well. + + To "convey" a work means any kind of propagation that enables other +parties to make or receive copies. Mere interaction with a user through +a computer network, with no transfer of a copy, is not conveying. + + An interactive user interface displays "Appropriate Legal Notices" +to the extent that it includes a convenient and prominently visible +feature that (1) displays an appropriate copyright notice, and (2) +tells the user that there is no warranty for the work (except to the +extent that warranties are provided), that licensees may convey the +work under this License, and how to view a copy of this License. If +the interface presents a list of user commands or options, such as a +menu, a prominent item in the list meets this criterion. + + 1. Source Code. + + The "source code" for a work means the preferred form of the work +for making modifications to it. "Object code" means any non-source +form of a work. + + A "Standard Interface" means an interface that either is an official +standard defined by a recognized standards body, or, in the case of +interfaces specified for a particular programming language, one that +is widely used among developers working in that language. + + The "System Libraries" of an executable work include anything, other +than the work as a whole, that (a) is included in the normal form of +packaging a Major Component, but which is not part of that Major +Component, and (b) serves only to enable use of the work with that +Major Component, or to implement a Standard Interface for which an +implementation is available to the public in source code form. A +"Major Component", in this context, means a major essential component +(kernel, window system, and so on) of the specific operating system +(if any) on which the executable work runs, or a compiler used to +produce the work, or an object code interpreter used to run it. + + The "Corresponding Source" for a work in object code form means all +the source code needed to generate, install, and (for an executable +work) run the object code and to modify the work, including scripts to +control those activities. However, it does not include the work's +System Libraries, or general-purpose tools or generally available free +programs which are used unmodified in performing those activities but +which are not part of the work. For example, Corresponding Source +includes interface definition files associated with source files for +the work, and the source code for shared libraries and dynamically +linked subprograms that the work is specifically designed to require, +such as by intimate data communication or control flow between those +subprograms and other parts of the work. + + The Corresponding Source need not include anything that users +can regenerate automatically from other parts of the Corresponding +Source. + + The Corresponding Source for a work in source code form is that +same work. + + 2. Basic Permissions. + + All rights granted under this License are granted for the term of +copyright on the Program, and are irrevocable provided the stated +conditions are met. This License explicitly affirms your unlimited +permission to run the unmodified Program. The output from running a +covered work is covered by this License only if the output, given its +content, constitutes a covered work. This License acknowledges your +rights of fair use or other equivalent, as provided by copyright law. + + You may make, run and propagate covered works that you do not +convey, without conditions so long as your license otherwise remains +in force. You may convey covered works to others for the sole purpose +of having them make modifications exclusively for you, or provide you +with facilities for running those works, provided that you comply with +the terms of this License in conveying all material for which you do +not control copyright. Those thus making or running the covered works +for you must do so exclusively on your behalf, under your direction +and control, on terms that prohibit them from making any copies of +your copyrighted material outside their relationship with you. + + Conveying under any other circumstances is permitted solely under +the conditions stated below. Sublicensing is not allowed; section 10 +makes it unnecessary. + + 3. Protecting Users' Legal Rights From Anti-Circumvention Law. + + No covered work shall be deemed part of an effective technological +measure under any applicable law fulfilling obligations under article +11 of the WIPO copyright treaty adopted on 20 December 1996, or +similar laws prohibiting or restricting circumvention of such +measures. + + When you convey a covered work, you waive any legal power to forbid +circumvention of technological measures to the extent such circumvention +is effected by exercising rights under this License with respect to +the covered work, and you disclaim any intention to limit operation or +modification of the work as a means of enforcing, against the work's +users, your or third parties' legal rights to forbid circumvention of +technological measures. + + 4. Conveying Verbatim Copies. + + You may convey verbatim copies of the Program's source code as you +receive it, in any medium, provided that you conspicuously and +appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate copyright notice; +keep intact all notices stating that this License and any +non-permissive terms added in accord with section 7 apply to the code; +keep intact all notices of the absence of any warranty; and give all +recipients a copy of this License along with the Program. + + You may charge any price or no price for each copy that you convey, +and you may offer support or warranty protection for a fee. + + 5. Conveying Modified Source Versions. + + You may convey a work based on the Program, or the modifications to +produce it from the Program, in the form of source code under the +terms of section 4, provided that you also meet all of these conditions: + + a) The work must carry prominent notices stating that you modified + it, and giving a relevant date. + + b) The work must carry prominent notices stating that it is + released under this License and any conditions added under section + 7. This requirement modifies the requirement in section 4 to + "keep intact all notices". + + c) You must license the entire work, as a whole, under this + License to anyone who comes into possession of a copy. This + License will therefore apply, along with any applicable section 7 + additional terms, to the whole of the work, and all its parts, + regardless of how they are packaged. This License gives no + permission to license the work in any other way, but it does not + invalidate such permission if you have separately received it. + + d) If the work has interactive user interfaces, each must display + Appropriate Legal Notices; however, if the Program has interactive + interfaces that do not display Appropriate Legal Notices, your + work need not make them do so. + + A compilation of a covered work with other separate and independent +works, which are not by their nature extensions of the covered work, +and which are not combined with it such as to form a larger program, +in or on a volume of a storage or distribution medium, is called an +"aggregate" if the compilation and its resulting copyright are not +used to limit the access or legal rights of the compilation's users +beyond what the individual works permit. Inclusion of a covered work +in an aggregate does not cause this License to apply to the other +parts of the aggregate. + + 6. Conveying Non-Source Forms. + + You may convey a covered work in object code form under the terms +of sections 4 and 5, provided that you also convey the +machine-readable Corresponding Source under the terms of this License, +in one of these ways: + + a) Convey the object code in, or embodied in, a physical product + (including a physical distribution medium), accompanied by the + Corresponding Source fixed on a durable physical medium + customarily used for software interchange. + + b) Convey the object code in, or embodied in, a physical product + (including a physical distribution medium), accompanied by a + written offer, valid for at least three years and valid for as + long as you offer spare parts or customer support for that product + model, to give anyone who possesses the object code either (1) a + copy of the Corresponding Source for all the software in the + product that is covered by this License, on a durable physical + medium customarily used for software interchange, for a price no + more than your reasonable cost of physically performing this + conveying of source, or (2) access to copy the + Corresponding Source from a network server at no charge. + + c) Convey individual copies of the object code with a copy of the + written offer to provide the Corresponding Source. This + alternative is allowed only occasionally and noncommercially, and + only if you received the object code with such an offer, in accord + with subsection 6b. + + d) Convey the object code by offering access from a designated + place (gratis or for a charge), and offer equivalent access to the + Corresponding Source in the same way through the same place at no + further charge. You need not require recipients to copy the + Corresponding Source along with the object code. If the place to + copy the object code is a network server, the Corresponding Source + may be on a different server (operated by you or a third party) + that supports equivalent copying facilities, provided you maintain + clear directions next to the object code saying where to find the + Corresponding Source. Regardless of what server hosts the + Corresponding Source, you remain obligated to ensure that it is + available for as long as needed to satisfy these requirements. + + e) Convey the object code using peer-to-peer transmission, provided + you inform other peers where the object code and Corresponding + Source of the work are being offered to the general public at no + charge under subsection 6d. + + A separable portion of the object code, whose source code is excluded +from the Corresponding Source as a System Library, need not be +included in conveying the object code work. + + A "User Product" is either (1) a "consumer product", which means any +tangible personal property which is normally used for personal, family, +or household purposes, or (2) anything designed or sold for incorporation +into a dwelling. In determining whether a product is a consumer product, +doubtful cases shall be resolved in favor of coverage. For a particular +product received by a particular user, "normally used" refers to a +typical or common use of that class of product, regardless of the status +of the particular user or of the way in which the particular user +actually uses, or expects or is expected to use, the product. A product +is a consumer product regardless of whether the product has substantial +commercial, industrial or non-consumer uses, unless such uses represent +the only significant mode of use of the product. + + "Installation Information" for a User Product means any methods, +procedures, authorization keys, or other information required to install +and execute modified versions of a covered work in that User Product from +a modified version of its Corresponding Source. The information must +suffice to ensure that the continued functioning of the modified object +code is in no case prevented or interfered with solely because +modification has been made. + + If you convey an object code work under this section in, or with, or +specifically for use in, a User Product, and the conveying occurs as +part of a transaction in which the right of possession and use of the +User Product is transferred to the recipient in perpetuity or for a +fixed term (regardless of how the transaction is characterized), the +Corresponding Source conveyed under this section must be accompanied +by the Installation Information. But this requirement does not apply +if neither you nor any third party retains the ability to install +modified object code on the User Product (for example, the work has +been installed in ROM). + + The requirement to provide Installation Information does not include a +requirement to continue to provide support service, warranty, or updates +for a work that has been modified or installed by the recipient, or for +the User Product in which it has been modified or installed. Access to a +network may be denied when the modification itself materially and +adversely affects the operation of the network or violates the rules and +protocols for communication across the network. + + Corresponding Source conveyed, and Installation Information provided, +in accord with this section must be in a format that is publicly +documented (and with an implementation available to the public in +source code form), and must require no special password or key for +unpacking, reading or copying. + + 7. Additional Terms. + + "Additional permissions" are terms that supplement the terms of this +License by making exceptions from one or more of its conditions. +Additional permissions that are applicable to the entire Program shall +be treated as though they were included in this License, to the extent +that they are valid under applicable law. If additional permissions +apply only to part of the Program, that part may be used separately +under those permissions, but the entire Program remains governed by +this License without regard to the additional permissions. + + When you convey a copy of a covered work, you may at your option +remove any additional permissions from that copy, or from any part of +it. (Additional permissions may be written to require their own +removal in certain cases when you modify the work.) You may place +additional permissions on material, added by you to a covered work, +for which you have or can give appropriate copyright permission. + + Notwithstanding any other provision of this License, for material you +add to a covered work, you may (if authorized by the copyright holders of +that material) supplement the terms of this License with terms: + + a) Disclaiming warranty or limiting liability differently from the + terms of sections 15 and 16 of this License; or + + b) Requiring preservation of specified reasonable legal notices or + author attributions in that material or in the Appropriate Legal + Notices displayed by works containing it; or + + c) Prohibiting misrepresentation of the origin of that material, or + requiring that modified versions of such material be marked in + reasonable ways as different from the original version; or + + d) Limiting the use for publicity purposes of names of licensors or + authors of the material; or + + e) Declining to grant rights under trademark law for use of some + trade names, trademarks, or service marks; or + + f) Requiring indemnification of licensors and authors of that + material by anyone who conveys the material (or modified versions of + it) with contractual assumptions of liability to the recipient, for + any liability that these contractual assumptions directly impose on + those licensors and authors. + + All other non-permissive additional terms are considered "further +restrictions" within the meaning of section 10. If the Program as you +received it, or any part of it, contains a notice stating that it is +governed by this License along with a term that is a further +restriction, you may remove that term. If a license document contains +a further restriction but permits relicensing or conveying under this +License, you may add to a covered work material governed by the terms +of that license document, provided that the further restriction does +not survive such relicensing or conveying. + + If you add terms to a covered work in accord with this section, you +must place, in the relevant source files, a statement of the +additional terms that apply to those files, or a notice indicating +where to find the applicable terms. + + Additional terms, permissive or non-permissive, may be stated in the +form of a separately written license, or stated as exceptions; +the above requirements apply either way. + + 8. Termination. + + You may not propagate or modify a covered work except as expressly +provided under this License. Any attempt otherwise to propagate or +modify it is void, and will automatically terminate your rights under +this License (including any patent licenses granted under the third +paragraph of section 11). + + However, if you cease all violation of this License, then your +license from a particular copyright holder is reinstated (a) +provisionally, unless and until the copyright holder explicitly and +finally terminates your license, and (b) permanently, if the copyright +holder fails to notify you of the violation by some reasonable means +prior to 60 days after the cessation. + + Moreover, your license from a particular copyright holder is +reinstated permanently if the copyright holder notifies you of the +violation by some reasonable means, this is the first time you have +received notice of violation of this License (for any work) from that +copyright holder, and you cure the violation prior to 30 days after +your receipt of the notice. + + Termination of your rights under this section does not terminate the +licenses of parties who have received copies or rights from you under +this License. If your rights have been terminated and not permanently +reinstated, you do not qualify to receive new licenses for the same +material under section 10. + + 9. Acceptance Not Required for Having Copies. + + You are not required to accept this License in order to receive or +run a copy of the Program. Ancillary propagation of a covered work +occurring solely as a consequence of using peer-to-peer transmission +to receive a copy likewise does not require acceptance. However, +nothing other than this License grants you permission to propagate or +modify any covered work. These actions infringe copyright if you do +not accept this License. Therefore, by modifying or propagating a +covered work, you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so. + + 10. Automatic Licensing of Downstream Recipients. + + Each time you convey a covered work, the recipient automatically +receives a license from the original licensors, to run, modify and +propagate that work, subject to this License. You are not responsible +for enforcing compliance by third parties with this License. + + An "entity transaction" is a transaction transferring control of an +organization, or substantially all assets of one, or subdividing an +organization, or merging organizations. If propagation of a covered +work results from an entity transaction, each party to that +transaction who receives a copy of the work also receives whatever +licenses to the work the party's predecessor in interest had or could +give under the previous paragraph, plus a right to possession of the +Corresponding Source of the work from the predecessor in interest, if +the predecessor has it or can get it with reasonable efforts. + + You may not impose any further restrictions on the exercise of the +rights granted or affirmed under this License. For example, you may +not impose a license fee, royalty, or other charge for exercise of +rights granted under this License, and you may not initiate litigation +(including a cross-claim or counterclaim in a lawsuit) alleging that +any patent claim is infringed by making, using, selling, offering for +sale, or importing the Program or any portion of it. + + 11. Patents. + + A "contributor" is a copyright holder who authorizes use under this +License of the Program or a work on which the Program is based. The +work thus licensed is called the contributor's "contributor version". + + A contributor's "essential patent claims" are all patent claims +owned or controlled by the contributor, whether already acquired or +hereafter acquired, that would be infringed by some manner, permitted +by this License, of making, using, or selling its contributor version, +but do not include claims that would be infringed only as a +consequence of further modification of the contributor version. For +purposes of this definition, "control" includes the right to grant +patent sublicenses in a manner consistent with the requirements of +this License. + + Each contributor grants you a non-exclusive, worldwide, royalty-free +patent license under the contributor's essential patent claims, to +make, use, sell, offer for sale, import and otherwise run, modify and +propagate the contents of its contributor version. + + In the following three paragraphs, a "patent license" is any express +agreement or commitment, however denominated, not to enforce a patent +(such as an express permission to practice a patent or covenant not to +sue for patent infringement). To "grant" such a patent license to a +party means to make such an agreement or commitment not to enforce a +patent against the party. + + If you convey a covered work, knowingly relying on a patent license, +and the Corresponding Source of the work is not available for anyone +to copy, free of charge and under the terms of this License, through a +publicly available network server or other readily accessible means, +then you must either (1) cause the Corresponding Source to be so +available, or (2) arrange to deprive yourself of the benefit of the +patent license for this particular work, or (3) arrange, in a manner +consistent with the requirements of this License, to extend the patent +license to downstream recipients. "Knowingly relying" means you have +actual knowledge that, but for the patent license, your conveying the +covered work in a country, or your recipient's use of the covered work +in a country, would infringe one or more identifiable patents in that +country that you have reason to believe are valid. + + If, pursuant to or in connection with a single transaction or +arrangement, you convey, or propagate by procuring conveyance of, a +covered work, and grant a patent license to some of the parties +receiving the covered work authorizing them to use, propagate, modify +or convey a specific copy of the covered work, then the patent license +you grant is automatically extended to all recipients of the covered +work and works based on it. + + A patent license is "discriminatory" if it does not include within +the scope of its coverage, prohibits the exercise of, or is +conditioned on the non-exercise of one or more of the rights that are +specifically granted under this License. You may not convey a covered +work if you are a party to an arrangement with a third party that is +in the business of distributing software, under which you make payment +to the third party based on the extent of your activity of conveying +the work, and under which the third party grants, to any of the +parties who would receive the covered work from you, a discriminatory +patent license (a) in connection with copies of the covered work +conveyed by you (or copies made from those copies), or (b) primarily +for and in connection with specific products or compilations that +contain the covered work, unless you entered into that arrangement, +or that patent license was granted, prior to 28 March 2007. + + Nothing in this License shall be construed as excluding or limiting +any implied license or other defenses to infringement that may +otherwise be available to you under applicable patent law. + + 12. No Surrender of Others' Freedom. + + If conditions are imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement or +otherwise) that contradict the conditions of this License, they do not +excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you cannot convey a +covered work so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this +License and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you may +not convey it at all. For example, if you agree to terms that obligate you +to collect a royalty for further conveying from those to whom you convey +the Program, the only way you could satisfy both those terms and this +License would be to refrain entirely from conveying the Program. + + 13. Use with the GNU Affero General Public License. + + Notwithstanding any other provision of this License, you have +permission to link or combine any covered work with a work licensed +under version 3 of the GNU Affero General Public License into a single +combined work, and to convey the resulting work. The terms of this +License will continue to apply to the part which is the covered work, +but the special requirements of the GNU Affero General Public License, +section 13, concerning interaction through a network will apply to the +combination as such. + + 14. Revised Versions of this License. + + The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions of +the GNU General Public License from time to time. Such new versions will +be similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to +address new problems or concerns. + + Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the +Program specifies that a certain numbered version of the GNU General +Public License "or any later version" applies to it, you have the +option of following the terms and conditions either of that numbered +version or of any later version published by the Free Software +Foundation. If the Program does not specify a version number of the +GNU General Public License, you may choose any version ever published +by the Free Software Foundation. + + If the Program specifies that a proxy can decide which future +versions of the GNU General Public License can be used, that proxy's +public statement of acceptance of a version permanently authorizes you +to choose that version for the Program. + + Later license versions may give you additional or different +permissions. However, no additional obligations are imposed on any +author or copyright holder as a result of your choosing to follow a +later version. + + 15. Disclaimer of Warranty. + + THERE IS NO WARRANTY FOR THE PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY +APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT +HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE PROGRAM "AS IS" WITHOUT WARRANTY +OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, +THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR +PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM +IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE PROGRAM PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF +ALL NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION. + + 16. Limitation of Liability. + + IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING +WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO MODIFIES AND/OR CONVEYS +THE PROGRAM AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY +GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE +USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF +DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD +PARTIES OR A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER PROGRAMS), +EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF +SUCH DAMAGES. + + 17. Interpretation of Sections 15 and 16. + + If the disclaimer of warranty and limitation of liability provided +above cannot be given local legal effect according to their terms, +reviewing courts shall apply local law that most closely approximates +an absolute waiver of all civil liability in connection with the +Program, unless a warranty or assumption of liability accompanies a +copy of the Program in return for a fee. + + END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS + + How to Apply These Terms to Your New Programs + + If you develop a new program, and you want it to be of the greatest +possible use to the public, the best way to achieve this is to make it +free software which everyone can redistribute and change under these terms. + + To do so, attach the following notices to the program. It is safest +to attach them to the start of each source file to most effectively +state the exclusion of warranty; and each file should have at least +the "copyright" line and a pointer to where the full notice is found. + + <one line to give the program's name and a brief idea of what it does.> + Copyright (C) <year> <name of author> + + This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify + it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by + the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or + (at your option) any later version. + + This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the + GNU General Public License for more details. + + You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License + along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. + +Also add information on how to contact you by electronic and paper mail. + + If the program does terminal interaction, make it output a short +notice like this when it starts in an interactive mode: + + <program> Copyright (C) <year> <name of author> + This program comes with ABSOLUTELY NO WARRANTY; for details type `show w'. + This is free software, and you are welcome to redistribute it + under certain conditions; type `show c' for details. + +The hypothetical commands `show w' and `show c' should show the appropriate +parts of the General Public License. Of course, your program's commands +might be different; for a GUI interface, you would use an "about box". + + You should also get your employer (if you work as a programmer) or school, +if any, to sign a "copyright disclaimer" for the program, if necessary. +For more information on this, and how to apply and follow the GNU GPL, see +<http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. + + The GNU General Public License does not permit incorporating your program +into proprietary programs. If your program is a subroutine library, you +may consider it more useful to permit linking proprietary applications with +the library. If this is what you want to do, use the GNU Lesser General +Public License instead of this License. But first, please read +<http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/why-not-lgpl.html>. + + GNU LESSER GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE + Version 3, 29 June 2007 + + Copyright (C) 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc. <http://fsf.org/> + Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies + of this license document, but changing it is not allowed. + + + This version of the GNU Lesser General Public License incorporates +the terms and conditions of version 3 of the GNU General Public +License, supplemented by the additional permissions listed below. + + 0. Additional Definitions. + + As used herein, "this License" refers to version 3 of the GNU Lesser +General Public License, and the "GNU GPL" refers to version 3 of the GNU +General Public License. + + "The Library" refers to a covered work governed by this License, +other than an Application or a Combined Work as defined below. + + An "Application" is any work that makes use of an interface provided +by the Library, but which is not otherwise based on the Library. +Defining a subclass of a class defined by the Library is deemed a mode +of using an interface provided by the Library. + + A "Combined Work" is a work produced by combining or linking an +Application with the Library. The particular version of the Library +with which the Combined Work was made is also called the "Linked +Version". + + The "Minimal Corresponding Source" for a Combined Work means the +Corresponding Source for the Combined Work, excluding any source code +for portions of the Combined Work that, considered in isolation, are +based on the Application, and not on the Linked Version. + + The "Corresponding Application Code" for a Combined Work means the +object code and/or source code for the Application, including any data +and utility programs needed for reproducing the Combined Work from the +Application, but excluding the System Libraries of the Combined Work. + + 1. Exception to Section 3 of the GNU GPL. + + You may convey a covered work under sections 3 and 4 of this License +without being bound by section 3 of the GNU GPL. + + 2. Conveying Modified Versions. + + If you modify a copy of the Library, and, in your modifications, a +facility refers to a function or data to be supplied by an Application +that uses the facility (other than as an argument passed when the +facility is invoked), then you may convey a copy of the modified +version: + + a) under this License, provided that you make a good faith effort to + ensure that, in the event an Application does not supply the + function or data, the facility still operates, and performs + whatever part of its purpose remains meaningful, or + + b) under the GNU GPL, with none of the additional permissions of + this License applicable to that copy. + + 3. Object Code Incorporating Material from Library Header Files. + + The object code form of an Application may incorporate material from +a header file that is part of the Library. You may convey such object +code under terms of your choice, provided that, if the incorporated +material is not limited to numerical parameters, data structure +layouts and accessors, or small macros, inline functions and templates +(ten or fewer lines in length), you do both of the following: + + a) Give prominent notice with each copy of the object code that the + Library is used in it and that the Library and its use are + covered by this License. + + b) Accompany the object code with a copy of the GNU GPL and this license + document. + + 4. Combined Works. + + You may convey a Combined Work under terms of your choice that, +taken together, effectively do not restrict modification of the +portions of the Library contained in the Combined Work and reverse +engineering for debugging such modifications, if you also do each of +the following: + + a) Give prominent notice with each copy of the Combined Work that + the Library is used in it and that the Library and its use are + covered by this License. + + b) Accompany the Combined Work with a copy of the GNU GPL and this license + document. + + c) For a Combined Work that displays copyright notices during + execution, include the copyright notice for the Library among + these notices, as well as a reference directing the user to the + copies of the GNU GPL and this license document. + + d) Do one of the following: + + 0) Convey the Minimal Corresponding Source under the terms of this + License, and the Corresponding Application Code in a form + suitable for, and under terms that permit, the user to + recombine or relink the Application with a modified version of + the Linked Version to produce a modified Combined Work, in the + manner specified by section 6 of the GNU GPL for conveying + Corresponding Source. + + 1) Use a suitable shared library mechanism for linking with the + Library. A suitable mechanism is one that (a) uses at run time + a copy of the Library already present on the user's computer + system, and (b) will operate properly with a modified version + of the Library that is interface-compatible with the Linked + Version. + + e) Provide Installation Information, but only if you would otherwise + be required to provide such information under section 6 of the + GNU GPL, and only to the extent that such information is + necessary to install and execute a modified version of the + Combined Work produced by recombining or relinking the + Application with a modified version of the Linked Version. (If + you use option 4d0, the Installation Information must accompany + the Minimal Corresponding Source and Corresponding Application + Code. If you use option 4d1, you must provide the Installation + Information in the manner specified by section 6 of the GNU GPL + for conveying Corresponding Source.) + + 5. Combined Libraries. + + You may place library facilities that are a work based on the +Library side by side in a single library together with other library +facilities that are not Applications and are not covered by this +License, and convey such a combined library under terms of your +choice, if you do both of the following: + + a) Accompany the combined library with a copy of the same work based + on the Library, uncombined with any other library facilities, + conveyed under the terms of this License. + + b) Give prominent notice with the combined library that part of it + is a work based on the Library, and explaining where to find the + accompanying uncombined form of the same work. + + 6. Revised Versions of the GNU Lesser General Public License. + + The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions +of the GNU Lesser General Public License from time to time. Such new +versions will be similar in spirit to the present version, but may +differ in detail to address new problems or concerns. + + Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the +Library as you received it specifies that a certain numbered version +of the GNU Lesser General Public License "or any later version" +applies to it, you have the option of following the terms and +conditions either of that published version or of any later version +published by the Free Software Foundation. If the Library as you +received it does not specify a version number of the GNU Lesser +General Public License, you may choose any version of the GNU Lesser +General Public License ever published by the Free Software Foundation. + + If the Library as you received it specifies that a proxy can decide +whether future versions of the GNU Lesser General Public License shall +apply, that proxy's public statement of acceptance of any version is +permanent authorization for you to choose that version for the +Library. + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/x86/libusb0.sys b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/x86/libusb0.sys Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5322e5b978 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/x86/libusb0.sys diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/x86/libusb0_x86.dll b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/x86/libusb0_x86.dll Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6e475b90ac --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/x86/libusb0_x86.dll diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d774b8c6bb --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,91 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0"> + <project caption="AVRISP-MKII Clone Programmer" id="lufa.projects.avrispmkii_clone.avr8"> + <require idref="lufa.projects.avrispmkii_clone"/> + <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/> + <generator value="as5_8"/> + + <device-support value="at90usb1287"/> + <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="usbkey"/> + + <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="8000000UL"/> + <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="8000000UL"/> + </project> + + <!-- Required by the XPLAIN Bridge project as well, so split into a meta module --> + <module type="meta" id="lufa.projects.avrispmkii_clone.src" caption="AVRISP-MKII Clone Programmer"> + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/> + + <build type="include-path" value="."/> + + <build type="c-source" value="AVRISPDescriptors.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="AVRISPDescriptors.h"/> + + <build type="include-path" value="Lib"/> + + <build type="header-file" value="Lib/V2ProtocolConstants.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Lib/V2Protocol.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Lib/V2Protocol.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Lib/V2ProtocolParams.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Lib/V2ProtocolParams.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Lib/ISP/ISPProtocol.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Lib/ISP/ISPProtocol.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Lib/ISP/ISPTarget.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Lib/ISP/ISPTarget.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Lib/XPROG/XPROGTarget.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Lib/XPROG/XPROGTarget.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Lib/XPROG/XPROGProtocol.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Lib/XPROG/XPROGProtocol.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Lib/XPROG/XMEGANVM.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Lib/XPROG/XMEGANVM.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Lib/XPROG/TINYNVM.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Lib/XPROG/TINYNVM.h"/> + + <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.adc"/> + <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.spi"/> + </module> + + <module type="application" id="lufa.projects.avrispmkii_clone" caption="AVRISP-MKII Clone Programmer"> + <info type="description" value="summary"> + Clone firmware of the Atmel AVRISP-MKII programmer. + </info> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/> + + <info type="keyword" value="Technology"> + <keyword value="Low Level APIs"/> + <keyword value="USB Device"/> + </info> + + <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> + + <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/> + <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="AVRISP-MKII.txt"/> + <build type="distribute" subtype="directory" value="WindowsDriver"/> + + <build type="c-source" value="AVRISP-MKII.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="AVRISP-MKII.h"/> + + <require idref="lufa.projects.avrispmkii_clone.src"/> + + <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/> + <build type="module-config" subtype="required-header-file" value="AppConfig.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Config/AppConfig.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/> + + <require idref="lufa.common"/> + <require idref="lufa.platform"/> + <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/> + <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.adc"/> + <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.spi"/> + <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/> + <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/> + </module> +</asf> diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..faba2c70d2 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2396 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "AVRISP-MKII Clone Programmer Project" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ \ + WindowsDriver/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/makefile b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6bc0e0f25a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,44 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = AVRISP-MKII +SRC = $(TARGET).c AVRISPDescriptors.c Lib/V2Protocol.c Lib/V2ProtocolParams.c Lib/ISP/ISPProtocol.c Lib/ISP/ISPTarget.c Lib/XPROG/XPROGProtocol.c \ + Lib/XPROG/XPROGTarget.c Lib/XPROG/XMEGANVM.c Lib/XPROG/TINYNVM.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) +LUFA_PATH = ../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk |